blob: 7e6799793af2b84c4578e4d0bacd12e1e373ba88 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaub06ed2c2011-03-29 01:10:33 +02007 2011/03/29
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100438 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200439 - nbproc
440 - pidfile
441 - uid
442 - ulimit-n
443 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200444 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200445 - node
446 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100447 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200449 * Performance tuning
450 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100451 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - noepoll
453 - nokqueue
454 - nopoll
455 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200457 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200458 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200459 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100460 - tune.maxaccept
461 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200462 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100463 - tune.rcvbuf.client
464 - tune.rcvbuf.server
465 - tune.sndbuf.client
466 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100467
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 * Debugging
469 - debug
470 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471
472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004733.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200474------------------------------------
475
476chroot <jail dir>
477 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
478 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
479 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
480 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
481 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
482 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100483
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484daemon
485 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
486 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
487 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
488
489gid <number>
490 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
491 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
492 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
493 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200495group <group name>
496 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
497 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200499log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
501 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100502 configured with "log global".
503
504 <address> can be one of:
505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
508 port).
509
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100510 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100514 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
515 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
516 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
517 writeable).
518
519 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520
521 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
522 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
523 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
524
525 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200526 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
527 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
528 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
529 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
530 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
531 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532
533 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
534
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100535log-send-hostname [<string>]
536 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
537 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
538 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
539 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
540 the logs.
541
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000542log-tag <string>
543 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
544 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
545 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
546 running on the same host.
547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548nbproc <number>
549 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
550 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
551 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
552 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
553 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
554
555pidfile <pidfile>
556 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
557 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
558 starting the process. See also "daemon".
559
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200560stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200561 [level <level>]
562
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200563 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
564 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100565 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200566 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
567
568 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
569 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
570 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
571 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
572 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
573
574 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
575 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
576 counters).
577
578 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
579 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100580
581 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
582 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
583 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
584 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
585 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
586 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
587 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200588
589stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
590 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
591 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100592 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats maxconn <connections>
595 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
596 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
597
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598uid <number>
599 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
600 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
601 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
602 one. See also "gid" and "user".
603
604ulimit-n <number>
605 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
606 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
607 option.
608
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100609unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
610 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
611
612 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
613 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
614 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
615 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
616 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
617 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
618 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
619 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
620 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
621 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623user <user name>
624 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
625 See also "uid" and "group".
626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200627node <name>
628 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
629
630 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
631 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
632 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
633 traffic.
634
635description <text>
636 Add a text that describes the instance.
637
638 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
639 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
640 "<" and ">" characters.
641
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644-----------------------
645
646maxconn <number>
647 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
648 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
649 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
650 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
651
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652maxpipes <number>
653 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
654 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
655 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
656 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
657 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
658 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
659
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660noepoll
661 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
662 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
663 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
664
665nokqueue
666 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
667 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
668 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
669
670nopoll
671 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
672 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100673 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
675 "nokqueue".
676
677nosepoll
678 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
679 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
680 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
681
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100682nosplice
683 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
684 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
685 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100686 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100687 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
688 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
689 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
690 "option splice-response".
691
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200692spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
693 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
694 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
695 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
696 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
697 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
698
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200699tune.bufsize <number>
700 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
701 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
702 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
703 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
704 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
705 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
706 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
707 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
708
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200709tune.chksize <number>
710 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
711 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
712 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
713 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
714 checks whenever possible.
715
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100716tune.maxaccept <number>
717 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
718 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
719 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100720 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100721 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
722 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100723 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100724 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
725
726tune.maxpollevents <number>
727 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
728 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
729 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
730 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
731 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
732
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200733tune.maxrewrite <number>
734 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
735 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
736 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
737 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
738 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
739 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
740 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
741 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
742 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
743 bufsize.
744
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100745tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
746tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
747 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
748 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
749 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
750 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
751 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
752 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
753 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
754
755tune.sndbuf.client <number>
756tune.sndbuf.server <number>
757 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
758 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
759 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
760 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
761 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
762 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
763 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
764 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
765 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
766 notifying haproxy again.
767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007693.3. Debugging
770--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771
772debug
773 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
774 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
775 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
776 system startup.
777
778quiet
779 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
780 line argument "-q".
781
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007833.4. Userlists
784--------------
785It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
786http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
787it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
788
789userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100790 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100791 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
792
793group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100794 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100795 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
796 proceeded by "users" keyword.
797
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100798user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
799 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100800 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
801 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100802 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
803 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100804 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
805 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
806
807
808 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100809 userlist L1
810 group G1 users tiger,scott
811 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100812
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100813 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
814 user scott insecure-password elgato
815 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100816
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100817 userlist L2
818 group G1
819 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100820
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100821 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
822 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
823 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824
825 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200826
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200827
8283.5. Peers
829--------------
830It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
831haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
832pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
833identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
834or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
835Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
836known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
837the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
838process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
839during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
840tables.
841
842peers <peersect>
843 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
844 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
845
846peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
847 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
848 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
849 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
850 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
851 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
852 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
853
854 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
855 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
856
857 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
858 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
859 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
860 across all peers.
861
862Example:
863 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100864 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
865 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
866 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200867
868 backend mybackend
869 mode tcp
870 balance roundrobin
871 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
872 stick on src
873
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100874 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
875 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200876
877
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008784. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200879----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
882 - defaults <name>
883 - frontend <name>
884 - backend <name>
885 - listen <name>
886
887A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
888its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
889section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100890section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
892A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
893connections.
894
895A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
896to forward incoming connections.
897
898A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
899parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100901All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
902'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
903case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
904
905Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
906logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
907proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
908However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
909name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
910
911Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
912and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
915modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
916arbitrary criteria.
917
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194.1. Proxy keywords matrix
920--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
923limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
924they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
925limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100926marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200927option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200928and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
929with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
930specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100933 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
934------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
935acl - X X X
936appsession - - X X
937backlog X X X -
938balance X - X X
939bind - X X -
940bind-process X X X X
941block - X X X
942capture cookie - X X -
943capture request header - X X -
944capture response header - X X -
945clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
946contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
947cookie X - X X
948default-server X - X X
949default_backend X X X -
950description - X X X
951disabled X X X X
952dispatch - - X X
953enabled X X X X
954errorfile X X X X
955errorloc X X X X
956errorloc302 X X X X
957-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
958errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200959force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960fullconn X - X X
961grace X X X X
962hash-type X - X X
963http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100964http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200965http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966http-request - X X X
967id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200968ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100969log X X X X
970maxconn X X X -
971mode X X X X
972monitor fail - X X -
973monitor-net X X X -
974monitor-uri X X X -
975option abortonclose (*) X - X X
976option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
977option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
978option allbackups (*) X - X X
979option checkcache (*) X - X X
980option clitcpka (*) X X X -
981option contstats (*) X X X -
982option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
983option dontlognull (*) X X X -
984option forceclose (*) X X X X
985-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
986option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200987option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100988option http-server-close (*) X X X X
989option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
990option httpchk X - X X
991option httpclose (*) X X X X
992option httplog X X X X
993option http_proxy (*) X X X X
994option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200995option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100996option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
997option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
998option logasap (*) X X X -
999option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001000option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001001option nolinger (*) X X X X
1002option originalto X X X X
1003option persist (*) X - X X
1004option redispatch (*) X - X X
1005option smtpchk X - X X
1006option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1007option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1008option splice-request (*) X X X X
1009option splice-response (*) X X X X
1010option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1011option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1012-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1013option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1014option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1015option tcpka X X X X
1016option tcplog X X X X
1017option transparent (*) X - X X
1018persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1019rate-limit sessions X X X -
1020redirect - X X X
1021redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1022redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1023reqadd - X X X
1024reqallow - X X X
1025reqdel - X X X
1026reqdeny - X X X
1027reqiallow - X X X
1028reqidel - X X X
1029reqideny - X X X
1030reqipass - X X X
1031reqirep - X X X
1032reqisetbe - X X X
1033reqitarpit - X X X
1034reqpass - X X X
1035reqrep - X X X
1036-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1037reqsetbe - X X X
1038reqtarpit - X X X
1039retries X - X X
1040rspadd - X X X
1041rspdel - X X X
1042rspdeny - X X X
1043rspidel - X X X
1044rspideny - X X X
1045rspirep - X X X
1046rsprep - X X X
1047server - - X X
1048source X - X X
1049srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001050stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001051stats auth X - X X
1052stats enable X - X X
1053stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001054stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001055stats realm X - X X
1056stats refresh X - X X
1057stats scope X - X X
1058stats show-desc X - X X
1059stats show-legends X - X X
1060stats show-node X - X X
1061stats uri X - X X
1062-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1063stick match - - X X
1064stick on - - X X
1065stick store-request - - X X
1066stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001067tcp-request connection - X X -
1068tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001069tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001070tcp-response content - - X X
1071tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001072timeout check X - X X
1073timeout client X X X -
1074timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1075timeout connect X - X X
1076timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1077timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1078timeout http-request X X X X
1079timeout queue X - X X
1080timeout server X - X X
1081timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1082timeout tarpit X X X X
1083transparent (deprecated) X - X X
1084use_backend - X X -
1085------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1086 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010894.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1090---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001091
1092This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1093
1094
1095acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1096 Declare or complete an access list.
1097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1098 no | yes | yes | yes
1099 Example:
1100 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1101 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1102 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001104 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001105
1106
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001107appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1108 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1111 no | no | yes | yes
1112 Arguments :
1113 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1114 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1115
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001116 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001117 checked in each cookie value.
1118
1119 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1120 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1121 milliseconds.
1122
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001123 request-learn
1124 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1125 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1126 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1127 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1128 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1129 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1130
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001131 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1132 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1133 data following this prefix.
1134
1135 Example :
1136 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1137
1138 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1139 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1140
1141 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1142 2 modes are currently supported :
1143 - path-parameters :
1144 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1145 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1146 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1147 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1148 - query-string :
1149 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1150 query string.
1151
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001152 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1153 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1154 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1155 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001156 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1157 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1158 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001159 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1160 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1161
1162 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1163
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001164 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1165 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1166 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168 Example :
1169 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1170
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001171 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1172 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001173
1174
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001175backlog <conns>
1176 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1178 yes | yes | yes | no
1179 Arguments :
1180 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1181 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1182 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1183
1184 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1185 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1186 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1187 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1188 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1189 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1190 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1191 backlog parameter.
1192
1193 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1194 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1195 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1196
1197 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1198
1199
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001200balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001201balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001202 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1204 yes | no | yes | yes
1205 Arguments :
1206 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1207 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1208 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1209 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1210
1211 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1212 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1213 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1214 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001215 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1216 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1217 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1218 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1219 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1220 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1221 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1222 it, so that you don't worry.
1223
1224 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1225 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1226 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1227 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1228 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1229 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1230 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1231 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001233 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1234 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1235 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1236 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1237 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1238 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1239 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1240 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1241
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001242 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1243 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1244 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1245 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1246 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1247 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1248 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1249 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001250 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001251 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001252 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1253 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1254 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001255
1256 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1257 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1258 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1259 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1260 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1261 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1262 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001263 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1264 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1265 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001267 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1268 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1269 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1270 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1271 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1272 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1273 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1274 URIs start with a leading "/".
1275
1276 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1277 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1278 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1279 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1280
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001281 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001282 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1283
1284 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1285 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001286 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1287 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001288 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1289 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1290 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1291 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1292 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1293 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1294 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1295 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1296 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1297 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1298 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1299 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1300 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1301 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1302 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1303 be randomly balanced if at all.
1304
1305 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1306 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1307 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1308 server will receive the request.
1309
1310 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1311 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1312 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1313 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1314 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001315 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1316 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1317 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001318
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001319 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1320 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1321 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001322 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001323 algorithm is applied instead.
1324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001325 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001326 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1327 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1328 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1329
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001330 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1331 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1332 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1333
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001334 rdp-cookie
1335 rdp-cookie(name)
1336 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1337 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1338 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1339 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1340 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1341 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001342 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001343 used instead.
1344
1345 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1346 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1347 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1348 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1349
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001350 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1351 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1352 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001354 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001355 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1356 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001357
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001358 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001359 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001360
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001361 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1362 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1363 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001364
1365 Examples :
1366 balance roundrobin
1367 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001368 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001369 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1370 balance hdr(host)
1371 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001372
1373 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1374 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001376 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001377 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1378 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1379 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1380 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1381
1382 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1383 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1384 defaults to 16 kB.
1385
1386 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1387 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1388
1389 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1390 Round Robin.
1391
1392 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1393 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1394 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1395 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1396
1397 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1398
1399 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001400 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001401 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1402 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1403 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001405 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1406 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001407
1408
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001409bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1410bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1411bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1412bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1413bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1414bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1415bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001416bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001417bind /<path> [, ...]
1418bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1419bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1420bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001421 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1423 no | yes | yes | no
1424 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001425 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1426 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1427 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1428 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001429 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001430
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001431 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1432 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001433 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1434 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1435 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001436 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1437 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1438 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1439 the range.
1440
1441 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1442 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1443 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1444 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1445 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1446 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1447 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1448 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1449 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001450
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001451 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1452 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1453 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1454 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1455 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1456 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1457 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1458 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1459
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001460 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1461 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1462 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1463 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1464 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1465 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1466 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1467 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001468 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1469 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001470
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001471 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1472 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1473 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1474 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1475 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1476 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001477 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1478 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1479 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1480 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1481 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1482 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1483 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1484 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001485
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001486 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1487 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1488 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1489 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001490
1491 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1492
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001493 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1494 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1495 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1496 simply ignore this.
1497
1498 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1499 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1500 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1501 simply ignore this.
1502
1503 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1504 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1505 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1506 this.
1507
1508 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1509 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1510 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1511 this.
1512
1513 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1514 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1515 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1516 this.
1517
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001518 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1519 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1520 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001521 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001522 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1523 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1524 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1525 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001526 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1527 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001528
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001529 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001530 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1531 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1532 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1533 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1534 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1535 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1536 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1537 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1538 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1539 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1540 with front firewalls which would see an established
1541 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1542
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001543 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1544 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1545 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1546 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1547 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1548 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1549 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1550 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1551 This keyword combined with support from external components
1552 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1553 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1554 not even always usable.
1555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001556 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1557 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1558 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1559 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1560 in a frontend.
1561
1562 Example :
1563 listen http_proxy
1564 bind :80,:443
1565 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001566 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001567
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001568 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001569 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
1571
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001572bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1573 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1575 yes | yes | yes | yes
1576 Arguments :
1577 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1578 may be used to override a default value.
1579
1580 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1581 option may be combined with other numbers.
1582
1583 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1584 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1585 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1586 missing from all processes.
1587
1588 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1589 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1590 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1591 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1592
1593 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1594 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1595 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1596 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1597 and 'even' instances.
1598
1599 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1600 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1601 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1602 32.
1603
1604 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1605 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1606
1607 Example :
1608 listen app_ip1
1609 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001610 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001611
1612 listen app_ip2
1613 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001614 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001615
1616 listen management
1617 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001618 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001619
1620 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1621
1622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001623block { if | unless } <condition>
1624 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1626 no | yes | yes | yes
1627
1628 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1629 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001630 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001631 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1632 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1633 "block" statements per instance.
1634
1635 Example:
1636 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1637 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1638 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1639 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001641 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642
1643
1644capture cookie <name> len <length>
1645 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1647 no | yes | yes | no
1648 Arguments :
1649 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1650 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1651 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1652 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1653 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1654
1655 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1656 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1657 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1658 right if it exceeds <length>.
1659
1660 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1661 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1662 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1663 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1664
1665 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1666 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1667 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1668
1669 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1670 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1671 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1672 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001673 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1675
1676 Example:
1677 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1678
1679 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001680 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
1682
1683capture request header <name> len <length>
1684 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1686 no | yes | yes | no
1687 Arguments :
1688 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001689 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1691 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1692 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1693
1694 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1695 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1696 it exceeds <length>.
1697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001698 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001699 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1700 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001701 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1702 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1703 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1704 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001705 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001706 environments to find where the request came from.
1707
1708 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1709 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1710 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1711 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001712
1713 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1714 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1715 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1716 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1717
1718 Example:
1719 capture request header Host len 15
1720 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1721 capture request header Referrer len 15
1722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001723 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001724 about logging.
1725
1726
1727capture response header <name> len <length>
1728 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1730 no | yes | yes | no
1731 Arguments :
1732 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001733 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1735 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1736 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1737
1738 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1739 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1740 it exceeds <length>.
1741
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001742 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1744 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1745 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001746 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1747 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1748 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1749 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001750
1751 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1752 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1753 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1754 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1755
1756 Example:
1757 capture response header Content-length len 9
1758 capture response header Location len 15
1759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001760 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761 about logging.
1762
1763
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001764clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001765 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1767 yes | yes | yes | no
1768 Arguments :
1769 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1770 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1771 as explained at the top of this document.
1772
1773 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1774 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1775 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1776 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1777 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1778 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1779 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1780 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001781 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001782 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1783 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1784
1785 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1786 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1787 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1788 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1789 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1790 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1791
1792 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1793 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1794
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001795 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1796 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797
1798
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001799contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1802 yes | no | yes | yes
1803 Arguments :
1804 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1805 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1806 as explained at the top of this document.
1807
1808 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001809 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001810 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1812 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1813 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1814 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1815
1816 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1817 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1818 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1819 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1820 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1821 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1822
1823 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1824 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1825 instead.
1826
1827 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1828 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1829
1830
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001831cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001832 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001833 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001834 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1836 yes | no | yes | yes
1837 Arguments :
1838 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1839 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1840 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1841 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1842 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1843 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1844 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1845 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1846 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1847
1848 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1849 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1850 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1851 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1852 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1853 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1854 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1855 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1856 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1857 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1858 "insert" and "prefix".
1859
1860 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001861 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001862
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001863 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001864 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1865 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1866 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1867 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1868 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1869 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1870 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1871 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1872 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1873 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001874
1875 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1876 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1877 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1878 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1879 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1880 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1881 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1882 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1883 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1884 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1885 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1886
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001887 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1888 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1889 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001890 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1891 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1892 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1893 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894
1895 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1896 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1897 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1898 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1899 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1900 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1901 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1902 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1903 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1904
1905 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1906 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1907 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1908 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1909 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1910 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1911 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1912 persistence cookie in the cache.
1913 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1914
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001915 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1916 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1917 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1918 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1919 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1920 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1921 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1922 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1923 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1924 they logout.
1925
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001926 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001927 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001928 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1929 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1930 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1931 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1932 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1933 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001934
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001935 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1936 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1937 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1938 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1939 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1940 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1941 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1942 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1943 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1944 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1945 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1946 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1947 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1948 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1949 the site.
1950
1951 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1952 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1953 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1954 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1955 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1956 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1957 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1958 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1959 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1960 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1961 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1962 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1963 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1964 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1965 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1966 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001968 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1969 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1970 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1971 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001973 Examples :
1974 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1975 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1976 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001977 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001978
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001979 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001980 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001983default-server [param*]
1984 Change default options for a server in a backend
1985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1986 yes | no | yes | yes
1987 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001988 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1989 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1990 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1991 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001992
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001993 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001994 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1995
1996 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001997
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001999default_backend <backend>
2000 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2002 yes | yes | yes | no
2003 Arguments :
2004 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2005
2006 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2007 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2008 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2009 will catch all undetermined requests.
2010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002011 Example :
2012
2013 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2014 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2015 default_backend dynamic
2016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002017 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019
2020disabled
2021 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2023 yes | yes | yes | yes
2024 Arguments : none
2025
2026 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2027 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2028 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2029 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2030 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2031 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2032 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2033
2034 See also : "enabled"
2035
2036
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002037dispatch <address>:<port>
2038 Set a default server address
2039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2040 no | no | yes | yes
2041 Arguments : none
2042
2043 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2044 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2045 during start-up.
2046
2047 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2048 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2049 possible with normal servers.
2050
2051 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
2052 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2053 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2054 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2055 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2056
2057 See also : "server"
2058
2059
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060enabled
2061 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2063 yes | yes | yes | yes
2064 Arguments : none
2065
2066 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2067 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2068
2069 See also : "disabled"
2070
2071
2072errorfile <code> <file>
2073 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2075 yes | yes | yes | yes
2076 Arguments :
2077 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2078 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2079
2080 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002081 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002083 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2084 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085
2086 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2087 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2088 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2089
2090 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2091 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2092 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2093 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2094
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002095 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2096 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2097 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2098 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2099 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2100 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2103 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2104 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002105 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002106 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2107
2108 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2109
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002110 Example :
2111 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2112 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2113 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2114
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002115
2116errorloc <code> <url>
2117errorloc302 <code> <url>
2118 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2120 yes | yes | yes | yes
2121 Arguments :
2122 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2123 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2124
2125 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2126 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2127 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2128 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2129 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2130
2131 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2132 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2133 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2134
2135 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2136 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2137 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2138 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2139 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2140 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2141 request.
2142
2143 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2144
2145
2146errorloc303 <code> <url>
2147 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2149 yes | yes | yes | yes
2150 Arguments :
2151 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2152 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2153
2154 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2155 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2156 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2157 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2158 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2159
2160 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2161 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2162 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2163
2164 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2165 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2166 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2167 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002168 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002169
2170 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2171
2172
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002173force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2174 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2175 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2176 no | yes | yes | yes
2177
2178 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2179 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2180 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2181 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2182 marked down for maintenance operations.
2183
2184 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2185 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2186 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2187 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2188 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2189 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2190 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2191 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2192 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2193
2194 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2195 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2196 is used.
2197
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002198 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002199 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002200
2201
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002202fullconn <conns>
2203 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2205 yes | no | yes | yes
2206 Arguments :
2207 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2208 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2209
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002210 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002211 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002212 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002213 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2214 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2215 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2216 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2217 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002218 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002219
2220 Example :
2221 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2222 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2223 # connections.
2224 backend dynamic
2225 fullconn 10000
2226 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2227 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2228
2229 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2230
2231
2232grace <time>
2233 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002235 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002236 Arguments :
2237 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2238 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2239 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2240
2241 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2242 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002243 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002244 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2245
2246 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2247 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2248 simplify it.
2249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002250
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002251hash-type <method>
2252 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2254 yes | no | yes | yes
2255 Arguments :
2256 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2257 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2258 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2259 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2260 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2261 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2262 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2263 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2264 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2265
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002266 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2267 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2268 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2269 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2270 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2271 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2272 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2273 this value.
2274
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002275 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2276 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2277 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2278 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2279 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2280 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2281 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2282 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2283 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2284 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2285 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2286 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2287 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2288
2289 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2290
2291 See also : "balance", "server"
2292
2293
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002294http-check disable-on-404
2295 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002297 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298 Arguments : none
2299
2300 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2301 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2302 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2303 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2304 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2305 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2306 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2307 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002308 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2309 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2310 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2311
2312 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2313
2314
2315http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2316 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2318 no | no | yes | yes
2319 Arguments :
2320 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2321 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2322 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2323 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2324 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2325 details on the supported keywords.
2326
2327 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2328 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2329 with the usual backslash ('\').
2330
2331 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2332 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2333 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2334 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2335 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2336
2337 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2338 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2339 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2340 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2341 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2342
2343 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2344 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2345 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2346 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2347 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2348 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2349
2350 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2351 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2352 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2353 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2354 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2355 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2356 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2357 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2358 trace).
2359
2360 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2361 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2362 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2363 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2364 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2365 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2366 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2367 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2368
2369 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2370 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2371 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2372 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2373 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2374 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2375 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2376 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2377
2378 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2379 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2380
2381 Examples :
2382 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002383 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002384
2385 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002386 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002387
2388 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002389 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002390
2391 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002392 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002394 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002395
2396
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002397http-check send-state
2398 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2400 yes | no | yes | yes
2401 Arguments : none
2402
2403 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2404 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2405 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2406 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2407 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2408
2409 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2410 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2411 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2412 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2413 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2414 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2415 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2416 checked in multiple backends.
2417
2418 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2419 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2420
2421 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2422 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2423 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2424 one fails.
2425
2426 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2427 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2428 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2429
2430 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2431 server's queue.
2432
2433 Example of a header received by the application server :
2434 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2435 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2436
2437 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2438
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002439http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002441 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2442
2443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2444 no | yes | yes | yes
2445
2446 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2447 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2448 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002449 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2450 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002451 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2452
2453 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2454 instance.
2455
2456 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002457 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2458 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2459 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002460
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002461 http-request allow if nagios
2462 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2463 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2464 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002465
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002466 Example:
2467 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002468
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002469 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002470
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002471 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2472 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002474id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002475 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2477 no | yes | yes | yes
2478 Arguments : none
2479
2480 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2481 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2482 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002483
2484
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002485ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2486 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2487 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2488 no | yes | yes | yes
2489
2490 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2491 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2492 and running).
2493
2494 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2495 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2496 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2497 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2498 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2499
2500 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2501 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2502
2503 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2504 "unless" condition is met.
2505
2506 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2507
2508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002509log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002510log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002511 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2513 yes | yes | yes | yes
2514 Arguments :
2515 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2516 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2517 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2518 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2519 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2520 parameter.
2521
2522 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2523 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2524
2525 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2526 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2527 standard syslog port).
2528
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002529 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2530 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2531 standard syslog port).
2532
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002533 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2534 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2535 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2536 appropriately writeable).
2537
2538 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2539
2540 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2541 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2542 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2543
2544 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2545 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2546 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002547 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2548 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2549 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2550 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2551 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002552
2553 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2554
2555 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2556 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2557 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2558
2559 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002560 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2561 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2562 "info".
2563
2564 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2565 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2566 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2567 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2568
2569 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2570 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002571
2572 Example :
2573 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002574 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2575 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002576
2577
2578maxconn <conns>
2579 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2581 yes | yes | yes | no
2582 Arguments :
2583 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2584 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2585 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2586 closes.
2587
2588 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2589 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2590 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2591 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2592 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2593 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2594 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2595 properly tuned.
2596
2597 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2598 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2599 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2600
2601 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2602
2603
2604mode { tcp|http|health }
2605 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2607 yes | yes | yes | yes
2608 Arguments :
2609 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2610 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2611 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2612 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2613
2614 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2615 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2616 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2617 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2618 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2619
2620 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2621 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2622 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2623 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2624 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2625 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2626
2627 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2628 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2629 will be refused.
2630
2631 Example :
2632 defaults http_instances
2633 mode http
2634
2635 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002638monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002639 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642 Arguments :
2643 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2644 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002645 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2647 backend and its backup.
2648
2649 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2650 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2651 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2652 servers in a list of backends.
2653
2654 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2655 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2656 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2657 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2658 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2659 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2660 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002661 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662
2663 Example:
2664 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002665 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2667 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2668 monitor-uri /site_alive
2669 monitor fail if site_dead
2670
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002671 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2672
2673
2674monitor-net <source>
2675 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2677 yes | yes | yes | no
2678 Arguments :
2679 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2680 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2681 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2682 followed by a mask.
2683
2684 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2685 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002686 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002687 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2688
2689 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2690 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2691 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2692 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2693 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2694
2695 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2696 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2697 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2698 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2699 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2700
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002701 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2702 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2703
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002704 Example :
2705 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2706 frontend www
2707 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2708
2709 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2710
2711
2712monitor-uri <uri>
2713 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2715 yes | yes | yes | no
2716 Arguments :
2717 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2718 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2719
2720 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2721 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2722 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2723 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2724 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2725 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2726 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2727 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2728
2729 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2730 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2731 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2732 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2733 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2734 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2735
2736 Example :
2737 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2738 frontend www
2739 mode http
2740 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2741
2742 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002745option abortonclose
2746no option abortonclose
2747 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2749 yes | no | yes | yes
2750 Arguments : none
2751
2752 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2753 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2754 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2755 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002756 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002757 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2758 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2759 encountered while delivering the response.
2760
2761 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2762 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2763 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2764 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2765 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2766 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002767 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002768 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002769 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002770 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2771 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2772 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2773
2774 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2775 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2776 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2777 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2778 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2779 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2780 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2781 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002782 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002783
2784 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2785 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2786
2787 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2788
2789
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002790option accept-invalid-http-request
2791no option accept-invalid-http-request
2792 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2794 yes | yes | yes | no
2795 Arguments : none
2796
2797 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2798 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2799 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2800 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2801 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2802 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2803 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2804 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2805 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2806
2807 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2808 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2809 been confirmed.
2810
2811 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2812 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2813 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2814 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2815
2816 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2817 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2818
2819 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2820 stats socket.
2821
2822
2823option accept-invalid-http-response
2824no option accept-invalid-http-response
2825 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2827 yes | no | yes | yes
2828 Arguments : none
2829
2830 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2831 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2832 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2833 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2834 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2835 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2836 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2837 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2838 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2839
2840 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2841 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2842 been confirmed.
2843
2844 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2845 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2846 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2847 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2848
2849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2851
2852 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2853 stats socket.
2854
2855
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002856option allbackups
2857no option allbackups
2858 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2860 yes | no | yes | yes
2861 Arguments : none
2862
2863 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2864 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2865 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2866 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2867 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2868 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2869 order between the backup servers anymore.
2870
2871 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2872 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2873
2874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2876
2877
2878option checkcache
2879no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002880 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 yes | no | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : none
2884
2885 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2886 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002887 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002888 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2889 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2890 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2891
2892 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002893 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002894 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002895 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2896 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002897 to the client are :
2898 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002899 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002900 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002901 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2902 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2903 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2904 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2905 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2906 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2907 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2908 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2909 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2910 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2911 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2912
2913 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002914 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002915 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002916 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002917 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2918
2919 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2920 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002921 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002922 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2923
2924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2926
2927
2928option clitcpka
2929no option clitcpka
2930 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2932 yes | yes | yes | no
2933 Arguments : none
2934
2935 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2936 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2937 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2938 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2939
2940 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2941 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2942 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2943 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2944
2945 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2946 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2947 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2948 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2949 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2950
2951 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2952
2953 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2954 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2955 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2956
2957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2959
2960 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2961
2962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963option contstats
2964 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2966 yes | yes | yes | no
2967 Arguments : none
2968
2969 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2970 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2971 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2972 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2973 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2974 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2975 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2976
2977
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002978option dontlog-normal
2979no option dontlog-normal
2980 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2982 yes | yes | yes | no
2983 Arguments : none
2984
2985 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2986 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2987 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2988 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2989 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2990 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2991 logged.
2992
2993 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2994 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2995 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002997 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002998 logging.
2999
3000
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003001option dontlognull
3002no option dontlognull
3003 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3005 yes | yes | yes | no
3006 Arguments : none
3007
3008 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3009 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3010 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3011 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3012 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3013 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3014 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3015
3016 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3017 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3018 would not be logged.
3019
3020 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3021 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003023 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003024
3025
3026option forceclose
3027no option forceclose
3028 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003030 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003031 Arguments : none
3032
3033 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3034 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3035 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3036 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3037 global session times in the logs.
3038
3039 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003040 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003041 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3042 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3043 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3044 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003045
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003046 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3047 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3048 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3049
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003050 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3051 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3052
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003053 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003054
3055
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003056option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003057 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 yes | yes | yes | yes
3060 Arguments :
3061 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3062 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003063 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003064 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003065
3066 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3067 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3068 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3069 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3070 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3071 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3072 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003073 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3074 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3075 possible that the client has already brought one.
3076
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003077 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003078 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003079 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3080 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003081 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3082 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003083
3084 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3085 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3086 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3087 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3088 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3089 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3090 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3091
3092 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003093 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3094 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3095 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003096
3097 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3098 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3099 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3100 when using this option.
3101
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003102 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003103 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3104 frontend www
3105 mode http
3106 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3107
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003108 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3109 backend www
3110 mode http
3111 option forwardfor header X-Client
3112
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003113 See also : "option httpclose"
3114
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003115
3116option http-pretend-keepalive
3117no option http-pretend-keepalive
3118 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3120 yes | yes | yes | yes
3121 Arguments : none
3122
3123 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3124 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3125 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3126 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3127 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3128 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3129 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3130 consider the response complete.
3131
3132 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3133 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3134 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3135 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3136 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3137 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3138
3139 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3140 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3141 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3142 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3143 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3144 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3145 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3146
3147 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3148 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003149 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3150 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3151 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003152
3153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3155
3156 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3157
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003158
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003159option http-server-close
3160no option http-server-close
3161 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 yes | yes | yes | yes
3164 Arguments : none
3165
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003166 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3167 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3168 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3169 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3170 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3171 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3172 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3173 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3174 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3175 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3176 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3177 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003178
3179 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3180 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3181 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3182 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003183 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3184 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003185
3186 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3187 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003188 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3189 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3190 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003191
3192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3194
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003195 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3196 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003197
3198
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003199option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003200no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003201 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3203 yes | yes | yes | no
3204 Arguments : none
3205
3206 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3207 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3208 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3209 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3210 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3211 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3212 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3213
3214 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3215 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3216 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3217 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3218 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3219 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3220 request along its whole life.
3221
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003222 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3223 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3224 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3225 front of an existing proxy.
3226
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003227 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3228
3229 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3230 http-server-close".
3231
3232
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003233option httpchk
3234option httpchk <uri>
3235option httpchk <method> <uri>
3236option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3237 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3239 yes | no | yes | yes
3240 Arguments :
3241 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3242 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3243 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3244 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3245 ones.
3246
3247 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3248 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3249 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3250
3251 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3252 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3253 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3254 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3255 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3256
3257 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3258 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3259 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3260 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3261 the lack of any response.
3262
3263 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3264
3265 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3266 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3267 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3268
3269 Examples :
3270 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3271 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3272 backend https_relay
3273 mode tcp
3274 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3275 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3276
3277 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003278 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3279 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003280
3281
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003282option httpclose
3283no option httpclose
3284 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3286 yes | yes | yes | yes
3287 Arguments : none
3288
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003289 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3290 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3291 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3292 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3293 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3294 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3295 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003296
3297 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003298 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3299 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3300 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3301 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3302 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3303 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003304
3305 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3306 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3307 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003308 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3309 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003310
3311 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3312 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3313
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003314 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3315 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003316
3317
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003318option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003319 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3321 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003322 Arguments :
3323 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3324 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3325 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3326 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3327 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003328
3329 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3330 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3331 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3332 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3333 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3334 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3335 ports.
3336
3337 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3338
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3341 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3342 by default.
3343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003344 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003345
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003346
3347option http_proxy
3348no option http_proxy
3349 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | yes | yes | yes
3352 Arguments : none
3353
3354 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3355 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3356 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3357 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3358 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3359
3360 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3361 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3362 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3363 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003364 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003365 be analyzed.
3366
3367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3369
3370 Example :
3371 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3372 backend direct_forward
3373 option httpclose
3374 option http_proxy
3375
3376 See also : "option httpclose"
3377
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003378
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003379option independant-streams
3380no option independant-streams
3381 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3383 yes | yes | yes | yes
3384 Arguments : none
3385
3386 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3387 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3388 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3389 receive data or not.
3390
3391 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3392 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3393 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3394 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3395 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3396 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3397 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3398 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3399 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3400 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3401 socket buffers.
3402
3403 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3404 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3405 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3406 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3407 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3408
3409 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3410
3411
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003412option ldap-check
3413 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3415 yes | no | yes | yes
3416 Arguments : none
3417
3418 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3419 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3420 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3421 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3422
3423 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3424 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3425
3426 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3427 configure it.
3428
3429 Example :
3430 option ldap-check
3431
3432 See also : "option httpchk"
3433
3434
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003435option log-health-checks
3436no option log-health-checks
3437 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 yes | no | yes | yes
3440 Arguments : none
3441
3442 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3443 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3444 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3445 of additional information is limited.
3446
3447 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3448 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3449
3450 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3451
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003452
3453option log-separate-errors
3454no option log-separate-errors
3455 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3457 yes | yes | yes | no
3458 Arguments : none
3459
3460 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3461 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3462 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3463 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3464 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3465 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3466 provides very important information.
3467
3468 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3469 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3470 error logs.
3471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003472 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003473 logging.
3474
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003475
3476option logasap
3477no option logasap
3478 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3480 yes | yes | yes | no
3481 Arguments : none
3482
3483 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3484 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3485 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3486 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3487 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3488 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3489 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003490 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003491 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3492 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3493
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003494 Examples :
3495 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3496 mode http
3497 option httplog
3498 option logasap
3499 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3500
3501 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3502 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3503 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3504 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003506 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003507 logging.
3508
3509
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003510option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3511 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3513 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003514 Arguments :
3515 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3516 to MySQL server.
3517
3518 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3519 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3520 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3521 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3522 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3523 in the MySQL table, like this :
3524
3525 USE mysql;
3526 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3527 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3528
3529 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3530 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3531 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3532 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3533 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3534 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3535 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3536 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3537 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3538
3539 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3540 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003541
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003542 The check requires MySQL >=4.0, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003543
3544 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3545 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3546 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3547 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3548 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3549 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3550
3551 See also: "option httpchk"
3552
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003553option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3554 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3556 yes | no | yes | yes
3557 Arguments :
3558 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3559 to PostgreSQL server.
3560
3561 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3562 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3563 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3564 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3565
3566 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003567
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003568option nolinger
3569no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003570 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3572 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003573 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003574
3575 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3576 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3577 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3578 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3579 connections.
3580
3581 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3582 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3583 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3584 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3585 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3586 this too.
3587
3588 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3589 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3590 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3591
3592 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3593 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3594 for servers.
3595
3596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3598
3599
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003600option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3601 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 yes | yes | yes | yes
3604 Arguments :
3605 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3606 matching <network>
3607 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3608 header name.
3609
3610 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3611 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3612 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3613 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3614 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3615 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3616 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3617 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3618 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3619 possible that the client has already brought one.
3620
3621 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3622 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3623 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3624 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3625 header and requires different one.
3626
3627 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3628 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3629 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3630 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3631 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3632 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3633 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3634
3635 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3636 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3637 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3638 both are defined.
3639
3640 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3641 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3642 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3643 when using this option.
3644
3645 Examples :
3646 # Original Destination address
3647 frontend www
3648 mode http
3649 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3650
3651 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3652 backend www
3653 mode http
3654 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3655
3656 See also : "option httpclose"
3657
3658
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003659option persist
3660no option persist
3661 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3663 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003664 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003665
3666 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3667 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3668 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3669 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3670 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3671 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3672 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3673 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3674 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3675 redirected to another valid server.
3676
3677 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3678 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3679
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003680 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003681
3682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003683option redispatch
3684no option redispatch
3685 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3686 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3687 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003688 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003689
3690 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3691 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3692 be able to access the service anymore.
3693
3694 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3695 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3696
3697 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3698 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3699 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003701 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3702 "redisp" keywords.
3703
3704 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3705 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3706
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003707 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003708
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003709
3710option smtpchk
3711option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3712 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003715 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003716 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3717 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3718 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3719
3720 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3721 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3722 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3723
3724 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3725 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3726 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3727 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3728 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3729 dead server.
3730
3731 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3732 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3733 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3734 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3735
3736 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3737 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3738 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3739 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3740 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3741
3742 Example :
3743 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3744
3745 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003748option socket-stats
3749no option socket-stats
3750
3751 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3753 yes | yes | yes | no
3754
3755 Arguments : none
3756
3757
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003758option splice-auto
3759no option splice-auto
3760 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | yes
3763 Arguments : none
3764
3765 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3766 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3767 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3768 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003769 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003770 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3771 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3772 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3773 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3774
3775 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3776 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3777 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3778 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3779 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3780 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3781 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3782 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3783 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3784 keyword.
3785
3786 Example :
3787 option splice-auto
3788
3789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3791
3792 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3793 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3794
3795
3796option splice-request
3797no option splice-request
3798 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3800 yes | yes | yes | yes
3801 Arguments : none
3802
3803 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3804 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3805 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3806 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3807 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3808 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3809
3810 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3811
3812 Example :
3813 option splice-request
3814
3815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3817
3818 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3819 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3820
3821
3822option splice-response
3823no option splice-response
3824 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | yes | yes | yes
3827 Arguments : none
3828
3829 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3830 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3831 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3832 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3833 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3834 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3835
3836 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3837
3838 Example :
3839 option splice-response
3840
3841 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3842 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3843
3844 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3845 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3846
3847
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003848option srvtcpka
3849no option srvtcpka
3850 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3852 yes | no | yes | yes
3853 Arguments : none
3854
3855 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3856 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3857 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3858 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3859
3860 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3861 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3862 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3863 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3864
3865 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3866 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3867 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3868 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3869 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3870
3871 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3872
3873 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3874 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3875 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3876
3877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3879
3880 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3881
3882
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003883option ssl-hello-chk
3884 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | no | yes | yes
3887 Arguments : none
3888
3889 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3890 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3891 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3892 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3893 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3894 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3895 hello message.
3896
3897 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3898 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3899 messages, which is appreciable.
3900
3901 See also: "option httpchk"
3902
3903
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003904option tcp-smart-accept
3905no option tcp-smart-accept
3906 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3908 yes | yes | yes | no
3909 Arguments : none
3910
3911 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3912 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3913 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3914 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3915 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3916 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3917
3918 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3919 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3920 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3921 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3922
3923 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3924 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3925 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3926 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3927
3928 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3929 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3930 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3931
3932 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3933 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3934 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3935
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003936 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3937
3938
3939option tcp-smart-connect
3940no option tcp-smart-connect
3941 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3943 yes | no | yes | yes
3944 Arguments : none
3945
3946 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3947 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3948 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3949 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3950 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3951
3952 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3953 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3954 complex.
3955
3956 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3957 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3958 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3959
3960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3962
3963 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3964
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003965
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003966option tcpka
3967 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3969 yes | yes | yes | yes
3970 Arguments : none
3971
3972 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3973 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3974 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3975 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3976
3977 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3978 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3979 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3980 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3981
3982 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3983 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3984 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3985 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3986 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3987
3988 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3989
3990 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3991 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3992 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3993 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3994 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3995 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3996 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3997 backends.
3998
3999 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4000
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004001
4002option tcplog
4003 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4005 yes | yes | yes | yes
4006 Arguments : none
4007
4008 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4009 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4010 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4011 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4012 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4013 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4014 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4015 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4016
4017 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004019 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004020
4021
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004022option transparent
4023no option transparent
4024 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004026 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004027 Arguments : none
4028
4029 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4030 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4031 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4032 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4033 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4034 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4035 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4036 appropriate server.
4037
4038 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4039 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4040
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004041 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004042 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004043
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004044
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004045persist rdp-cookie
4046persist rdp-cookie(name)
4047 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | no | yes | yes
4050 Arguments :
4051 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004052 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4053 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004054
4055 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4056 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4057 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4058 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4059 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4060 forwarded to this server.
4061
4062 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4063 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4064 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004065 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004066 a single "listen" section.
4067
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004068 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4069 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4070 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4071
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004072 Example :
4073 listen tse-farm
4074 bind :3389
4075 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4076 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4077 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4078 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4079 persist rdp-cookie
4080 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4081 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4082 balance rdp-cookie
4083 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4084 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4085
4086 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
4087
4088
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004089rate-limit sessions <rate>
4090 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4092 yes | yes | yes | no
4093 Arguments :
4094 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4095 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4096
4097 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4098 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4099 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4100 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4101 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4102 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4103
4104 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4105 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4106 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4107 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4108
4109 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4110 listen smtp
4111 mode tcp
4112 bind :25
4113 rate-limit sessions 10
4114 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4115
4116 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
4117 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
4118
4119 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4120
4121
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004122redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4123redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004124 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 no | yes | yes | yes
4127
4128 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004129 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004130
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004131 Arguments :
4132 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4133 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4134 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4135 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004136 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4137 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4138 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4139 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004140
4141 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4142 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4143 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4144 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4145 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4146 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4147 location with a GET method.
4148
4149 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4150 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4151
4152 - "drop-query"
4153 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4154 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4155 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4156 with a location-type redirect.
4157
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004158 - "append-slash"
4159 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4160 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4161 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4162 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4163
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004164 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4165 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4166 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4167 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4168 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4169 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4170 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4171
4172 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4173 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4174 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4175 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4176 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4177 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4178 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004179
4180 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4181 acl clear dst_port 80
4182 acl secure dst_port 8080
4183 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004184 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004185 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004186 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4187
4188 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004189 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4190 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4191 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004192 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004193
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004194 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4195 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4196 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004198 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004199
4200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004201redisp (deprecated)
4202redispatch (deprecated)
4203 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004206 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004207
4208 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4209 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4210 be able to access the service anymore.
4211
4212 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4213 redistribute them to a working server.
4214
4215 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4216 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4217 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004219 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4220 "option redispatch" instead.
4221
4222 See also : "option redispatch"
4223
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004224
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004225reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004226 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4228 no | yes | yes | yes
4229 Arguments :
4230 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4231 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004232 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004233
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004234 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4235 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4236
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004237 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4238 the last header of an HTTP request.
4239
4240 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4241 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4242 responses.
4243
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004244 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4245 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4246 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4247
4248 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4249 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004250
4251
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004252reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4253reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004254 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 no | yes | yes | yes
4257 Arguments :
4258 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4259 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4260 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4261 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4262 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4263 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4264 ignores case.
4265
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004266 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4267 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4268
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004269 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4270 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4271 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4272 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004273 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004274
4275 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4276 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4277
4278 Example :
4279 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4280 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4281 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4282
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004283 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4284 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004285
4286
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004287reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4288reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004289 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 no | yes | yes | yes
4292 Arguments :
4293 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4294 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4295 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4296 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4297 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4298 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4299
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004300 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4301 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4302
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004303 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4304 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4305 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4306 next servers.
4307
4308 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4309 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4310 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4311
4312 Example :
4313 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4314 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4315 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4316
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004317 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4318 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004319
4320
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004321reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4322reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004323 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 no | yes | yes | yes
4326 Arguments :
4327 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4328 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4329 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4330 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4331 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4332 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4333 case.
4334
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004335 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4336 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4337
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004338 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4339 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4340 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4341 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004342 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004343
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004344 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004345 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004346 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004347
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004348 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4349 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4350
4351 Example :
4352 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4353 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4354 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4355
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004356 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4357 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004358
4359
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004360reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4361reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004362 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 no | yes | yes | yes
4365 Arguments :
4366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4367 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4368 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4369 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4370 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4371 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4372 case.
4373
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004374 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4375 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4376
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004377 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4378 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4379 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4380 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4381
4382 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4383 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4384
4385 Example :
4386 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4387 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4388 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4389 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4390
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004391 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4392 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004393
4394
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004395reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4396reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004397 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 no | yes | yes | yes
4400 Arguments :
4401 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4402 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4403 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4404 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4405 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4406 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4407
4408 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4409 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4410 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4411 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004412 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004413
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004414 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4415 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4416
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004417 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4418 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4419 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4420
4421 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4422 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4423 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4424 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4425 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4426
4427 Example :
4428 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4429 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4430 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4431 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4432
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004433 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4434 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004435
4436
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004437reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4438reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004439 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4441 no | yes | yes | yes
4442 Arguments :
4443 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4444 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4445 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4446 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4447 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4448 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4449 ignores case.
4450
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004451 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4452 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4453
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004454 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4455 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004456 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4457 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4458 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004459 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4460 not set.
4461
4462 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4463 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4464 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4465 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4466 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4467
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004468 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004469 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4470 # block all others.
4471 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4472 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4473
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004474 # block bad guys
4475 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4476 reqitarpit . if badguys
4477
4478 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4479 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004480
4481
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004482retries <value>
4483 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4485 yes | no | yes | yes
4486 Arguments :
4487 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4488 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4489 default value is 3.
4490
4491 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4492 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4493 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4494
4495 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4496 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4497
4498 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4499 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4500
4501 See also : "option redispatch"
4502
4503
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004504rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004505 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4507 no | yes | yes | yes
4508 Arguments :
4509 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4510 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004511 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004512
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004513 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4514 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4515
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004516 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4517 the last header of an HTTP response.
4518
4519 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4520 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4521 responses.
4522
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004523 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4524 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004525
4526
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004527rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4528rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004529 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 no | yes | yes | yes
4532 Arguments :
4533 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4534 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4535 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4536 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4537 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4538 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4539 ignores case.
4540
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004541 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4542 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4543
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004544 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4545 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4546 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4547 client.
4548
4549 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4550 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4551 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4552
4553 Example :
4554 # remove the Server header from responses
4555 reqidel ^Server:.*
4556
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004557 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4558 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004559
4560
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004561rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4562rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004563 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4565 no | yes | yes | yes
4566 Arguments :
4567 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4568 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4569 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4570 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4571 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4572 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4573 ignores case.
4574
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004575 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4576 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4577
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4579 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4580 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4581 case-sensitive.
4582
4583 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004584 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4585 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4586 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004587
4588 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4589 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4590
4591 Example :
4592 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4593 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4594
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004595 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4596 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004597
4598
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004599rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4600rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004601 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4603 no | yes | yes | yes
4604 Arguments :
4605 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4606 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4607 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4608 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4609 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4610 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4611 ignores case.
4612
4613 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4614 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4615 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4616 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004617 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004618
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004619 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4620 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4621
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004622 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4623 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4624 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4625
4626 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4627 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4628 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4629 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4630 are not case-sensitive.
4631
4632 Example :
4633 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4634 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4635
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004636 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4637 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004638
4639
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004640server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004641 Declare a server in a backend
4642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4643 no | no | yes | yes
4644 Arguments :
4645 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4646 appear in logs and alerts.
4647
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004648 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4649 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4650 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4651 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004652 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4653 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4654 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4655 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4656 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4657 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004658
4659 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4660 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4661 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4662 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4663 adding this value to the client's port.
4664
4665 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4666 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004667 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004668
4669 Examples :
4670 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4671 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004673 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004674
4675
4676source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004677source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004678source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004679 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 yes | no | yes | yes
4682 Arguments :
4683 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4684 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4685 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4686 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4687
4688 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4689 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004690 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4691 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4692 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004693
4694 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4695 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4696 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4697 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4698 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4699 <addr>.
4700
4701 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4702 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4703 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4704 port.
4705
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004706 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4707 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4708 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4709 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4710 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4711 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4712 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4713 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4714 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4715 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4716 HTTP header.
4717
4718 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4719 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4720 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4721 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4722 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4723 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4724 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4725 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4726 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4727 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4728
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004729 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4730 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4731 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4732 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4733 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4734 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4735
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004736 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4737 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4738 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4739 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4740
4741 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4742 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4743 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4744 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4745 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4746 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4747
4748 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4749 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4750 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4751 there are two methods :
4752
4753 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4754 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4755 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4756 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4757 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4758 of the client ranges may be used.
4759
4760 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4761 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4762 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4763 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4764 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4765 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4766 same session.
4767
4768 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4769 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4770 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4771 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4772 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4773 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4774
4775 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4776 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4777 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004778 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004779
4780 Examples :
4781 backend private
4782 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4783 source 192.168.1.200
4784
4785 backend transparent_ssl1
4786 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4787 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4788
4789 backend transparent_ssl2
4790 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4791 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4792 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4793
4794 backend transparent_ssl3
4795 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4796 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4797 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4798
4799 backend transparent_smtp
4800 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4801 # with Tproxy version 4.
4802 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4803
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004804 backend transparent_http
4805 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4806 # proxy.
4807 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004809 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004810 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004812
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004813srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4814 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 yes | no | yes | yes
4817 Arguments :
4818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4820 as explained at the top of this document.
4821
4822 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4823 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4824 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4825 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4826 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4827 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4828 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4829
4830 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4831 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4832 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4833 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4834 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004835 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004836 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004837 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004838
4839 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4840 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4841 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4842 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4843 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4844 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4845
4846 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4847 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4848
4849 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4850
4851
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004852stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4853 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4855 no | no | yes | yes
4856
4857 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4858 matched.
4859
4860 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4861 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4862
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004863 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4864 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4865 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4866
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004867 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4868 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4869 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4870 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004871
4872 Example :
4873 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4874 backend stats_localhost
4875 stats enable
4876 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4877
4878 Example :
4879 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4880 backend stats_auth
4881 stats enable
4882 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4883 stats admin if TRUE
4884
4885 Example :
4886 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4887 userlist stats-auth
4888 group admin users admin
4889 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4890 group readonly users haproxy
4891 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4892
4893 backend stats_auth
4894 stats enable
4895 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
4896 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
4897 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
4898 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
4899
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004900 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
4901 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4902 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004903
4904
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004905stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4906 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | no | yes | yes
4909 Arguments :
4910 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4911
4912 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4913
4914 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4915 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4916 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4917 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4918 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4919 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4920
4921 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4922 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4923 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4924 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4925
4926 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4927 report using "stats scope".
4928
4929 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4930 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4931 unobvious parameters.
4932
4933 Example :
4934 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4935 backend public_www
4936 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4937 stats enable
4938 stats hide-version
4939 stats scope .
4940 stats uri /admin?stats
4941 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4942 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4943 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4944
4945 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4946 backend private_monitoring
4947 stats enable
4948 stats uri /admin?stats
4949 stats refresh 5s
4950
4951 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4952
4953
4954stats enable
4955 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | no | yes | yes
4958 Arguments : none
4959
4960 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4961 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4962 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4963 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4964 - stats auth : no authentication
4965 - stats scope : no restriction
4966
4967 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4968 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4969 unobvious parameters.
4970
4971 Example :
4972 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4973 backend public_www
4974 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4975 stats enable
4976 stats hide-version
4977 stats scope .
4978 stats uri /admin?stats
4979 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4980 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4981 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4982
4983 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4984 backend private_monitoring
4985 stats enable
4986 stats uri /admin?stats
4987 stats refresh 5s
4988
4989 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4990
4991
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004992stats hide-version
4993 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004996 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004998 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4999 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5000 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5001 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5002 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5003 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005005 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5006 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5007 unobvious parameters.
5008
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005009 Example :
5010 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5011 backend public_www
5012 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005013 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005014 stats hide-version
5015 stats scope .
5016 stats uri /admin?stats
5017 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5018 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5019 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005020
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005021 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5022 backend private_monitoring
5023 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005024 stats uri /admin?stats
5025 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005026
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005027 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005028
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005029
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005030stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5031 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5032 Access control for statistics
5033
5034 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5035 no | no | yes | yes
5036
5037 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5038 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5039 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5040 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5041 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5042 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5043
5044 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5045 instance.
5046
5047 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5048 about ACL usage.
5049
5050
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005051stats realm <realm>
5052 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5054 yes | no | yes | yes
5055 Arguments :
5056 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5057 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5058 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5059
5060 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5061 using a backslash ('\').
5062
5063 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5064 only related to authentication.
5065
5066 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5067 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5068 unobvious parameters.
5069
5070 Example :
5071 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5072 backend public_www
5073 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5074 stats enable
5075 stats hide-version
5076 stats scope .
5077 stats uri /admin?stats
5078 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5079 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5080 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5081
5082 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5083 backend private_monitoring
5084 stats enable
5085 stats uri /admin?stats
5086 stats refresh 5s
5087
5088 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5089
5090
5091stats refresh <delay>
5092 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
5096 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5097 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5098 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5099 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5100 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5101 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5102
5103 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5104 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5105 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5106 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5107
5108 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5109 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5110 unobvious parameters.
5111
5112 Example :
5113 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5114 backend public_www
5115 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5116 stats enable
5117 stats hide-version
5118 stats scope .
5119 stats uri /admin?stats
5120 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5121 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5122 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5123
5124 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5125 backend private_monitoring
5126 stats enable
5127 stats uri /admin?stats
5128 stats refresh 5s
5129
5130 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5131
5132
5133stats scope { <name> | "." }
5134 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | no | yes | yes
5137 Arguments :
5138 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5139 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5140 section in which the statement appears.
5141
5142 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5143 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5144 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5145 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5146 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5147 exists.
5148
5149 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5150 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5151 unobvious parameters.
5152
5153 Example :
5154 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5155 backend public_www
5156 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5157 stats enable
5158 stats hide-version
5159 stats scope .
5160 stats uri /admin?stats
5161 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5162 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5163 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5164
5165 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5166 backend private_monitoring
5167 stats enable
5168 stats uri /admin?stats
5169 stats refresh 5s
5170
5171 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5172
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005173
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005174stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005175 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5177 yes | no | yes | yes
5178
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005179 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005180 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5181
5182 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5183 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5184
5185 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5186 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5187 unobvious parameters.
5188
5189 Example :
5190 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5191 backend private_monitoring
5192 stats enable
5193 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5194 stats uri /admin?stats
5195 stats refresh 5s
5196
5197 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5198 global section.
5199
5200
5201stats show-legends
5202 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5203 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5204 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5205 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5206 - IP (socket, server)
5207 - cookie (backend, server)
5208
5209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5211 unobvious parameters.
5212
5213 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5214
5215
5216stats show-node [ <name> ]
5217 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | no | yes | yes
5220 Arguments:
5221 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5222 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5223
5224 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5225 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5226 provided for each customer.
5227
5228 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5229 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5230 unobvious parameters.
5231
5232 Example:
5233 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5234 backend private_monitoring
5235 stats enable
5236 stats show-node Europe-1
5237 stats uri /admin?stats
5238 stats refresh 5s
5239
5240 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5241 section.
5242
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005243
5244stats uri <prefix>
5245 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5247 yes | no | yes | yes
5248 Arguments :
5249 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5250 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5251 query string.
5252
5253 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5254 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5255 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5256 possible to reach it in the application.
5257
5258 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005259 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005260 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5261 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5262 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5263 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5264
5265 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5266 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5267 an address or a port to statistics only.
5268
5269 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5270 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5271 unobvious parameters.
5272
5273 Example :
5274 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5275 backend public_www
5276 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5277 stats enable
5278 stats hide-version
5279 stats scope .
5280 stats uri /admin?stats
5281 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5282 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5283 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5284
5285 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5286 backend private_monitoring
5287 stats enable
5288 stats uri /admin?stats
5289 stats refresh 5s
5290
5291 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5292
5293
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005294stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5295 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005297 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005298
5299 Arguments :
5300 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5301 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5302 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5303 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5304
5305 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5306 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5307 the "stick-table" statement.
5308
5309 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5310 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5311 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5312 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5313 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5314
5315 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5316 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5317 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5318 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5319 transformation rules.
5320
5321 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5322 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5323 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5324 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5325 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5326 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5327 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5328
5329 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5330 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5331 ACL based conditions.
5332
5333 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5334 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5335 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5336 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5337
5338 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5339 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5340 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5341 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5342
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005343 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5344 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5345 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5346
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005347 Example :
5348 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5349 # last 30 minutes
5350 backend pop
5351 mode tcp
5352 balance roundrobin
5353 stick store-request src
5354 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5355 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5356 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5357
5358 backend smtp
5359 mode tcp
5360 balance roundrobin
5361 stick match src table pop
5362 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5363 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5364
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005365 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5366 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005367
5368
5369stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5370 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 no | no | yes | yes
5373
5374 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5375 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5376 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5377 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5378
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005379 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5380 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5381 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5382
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005383 Examples :
5384 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005385 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005386
5387 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5388 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5389 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5390
5391
5392 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5393 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5394 backend http
5395 mode http
5396 balance roundrobin
5397 stick on src table https
5398 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5399 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5400 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5401
5402 backend https
5403 mode tcp
5404 balance roundrobin
5405 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5406 stick on src
5407 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5408 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5409
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005410 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005411
5412
5413stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5414 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 no | no | yes | yes
5417
5418 Arguments :
5419 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5420 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5421 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5422 server is selected.
5423
5424 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5425 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5426 the "stick-table" statement.
5427
5428 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5429 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5430 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5431 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5432 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5433 address.
5434
5435 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5436 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5437 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5438 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5439 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5440 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5441 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5442 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5443 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5444 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5445
5446 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5447 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5448 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5449 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5450 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5451 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5452 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5453
5454 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5455 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5456 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5457 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5458
5459 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5460 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5461 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5462 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5463 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5464 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5465 another protocol or access method.
5466
5467 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5468 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5469 the request.
5470
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005471 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5472 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5473 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5474
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005475 Example :
5476 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5477 # last 30 minutes
5478 backend pop
5479 mode tcp
5480 balance roundrobin
5481 stick store-request src
5482 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5483 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5484 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5485
5486 backend smtp
5487 mode tcp
5488 balance roundrobin
5489 stick match src table pop
5490 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5491 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5492
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005493 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5494 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005495
5496
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005497stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005498 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5499 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005500 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005502 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005503
5504 Arguments :
5505 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5506 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5507 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5508 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5509
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005510 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5511 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5512 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5513 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5514
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005515 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5516 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5517 instance.
5518
5519 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5520 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5521 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5522 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5523 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5524 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005525 to 32 characters.
5526
5527 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5528 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5529 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5530 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5531 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5532 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005533
5534 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005535 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5536 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005537 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5538 increase.
5539
5540 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005541 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5542 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5543 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005544
5545 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5546 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5547 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5548 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5549 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5550 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5551 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5552 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5553 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5554 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5555 parameter (see below).
5556
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005557 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5558 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5559 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5560 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5561 soft restart.
5562
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005563 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5564
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005565 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5566 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5567 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5568 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5569 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5570 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5571 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5572 if not expiration delay is specified.
5573
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005574 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5575 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5576 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5577 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005578 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5579 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5580 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5581 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5582 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5583 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5584 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5585 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5586 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5587 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5588 types and their arguments.
5589
5590 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5591 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5592 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5593 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5594
5595 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5596 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5597 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5598 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5599
5600 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5601 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5602 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5603 they were received.
5604
5605 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5606 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5607 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5608 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5609 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5610
5611 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5612 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5613 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5614 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5615 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5616
5617 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5618 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5619 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5620
5621 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5622 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5623 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5624 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5625 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5626
5627 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5628 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5629 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5630 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5631 the client side.
5632
5633 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5634 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5635 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5636 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5637 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5638 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5639 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5640
5641 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5642 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5643 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5644 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5645 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5646 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5647 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5648
5649 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5650 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5652 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5653 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5654 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5655
5656 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5657 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5658 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5659 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5660
5661 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5662 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5663 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5664 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5665 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5666 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5667 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5668 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5669 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5670 recommended for better fairness.
5671
5672 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5673 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5674 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5675 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5676
5677 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5678 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5679 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5680 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5681 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5682 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5683 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5684 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5685 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5686 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005687
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005688 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5689 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005690 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5691 reference it.
5692
5693 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5694 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5695 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5696 as an exclusive stickiness.
5697
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005698 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5699 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5700 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5701 something that can be ignored.
5702
5703 Example:
5704 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5705 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5706 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5707 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5708
5709 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005710 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005711
5712
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005713stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5714 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5716 no | no | yes | yes
5717
5718 Arguments :
5719 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5720 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5721 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5722 server is selected.
5723
5724 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5725 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5726 the "stick-table" statement.
5727
5728 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5729 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5730 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5731 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5732
5733 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5734 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5735 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5736 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5737 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5738 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5739 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5740 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5741 rules.
5742
5743 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5744 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5745 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5746 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5747 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5748 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5749 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5750
5751 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5752 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5753 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5754 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5755
5756 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5757 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5758 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5759 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5760 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5761 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5762 another protocol or access method.
5763
5764 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5765
5766 Example :
5767 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5768 backend https
5769 mode tcp
5770 balance roundrobin
5771 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5772 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5773
5774 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5775 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5776
5777 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5778 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5779 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5780
5781 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5782 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5783
5784 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5785 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5786 # at offset 44.
5787
5788 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5789 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5790
5791 # Learn on response if server hello.
5792 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5793
5794 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5795 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5796
5797 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5798 extraction.
5799
5800
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005801tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5802 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5804 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005805 Arguments :
5806 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5807 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5808 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005809
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005810 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005811
5812 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5813 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005814 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5815 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5816 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5817 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5818 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5819 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005820
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005821 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5822 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5823 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5824 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005825
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005826 Three types of actions are supported :
5827 - accept :
5828 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5829 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5830 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005832 - reject :
5833 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5834 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5835 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5836 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5837 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5838 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5839 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5840 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5841 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5842 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5843 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5844 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005845
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005846 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5847 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5848 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5849 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5850 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5851 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5852 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5853 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5854 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005856 These actions take one or two arguments :
5857 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5858 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5859 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005861 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5862 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5863 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5864 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005865
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005866 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5867 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5868 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5869 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5870 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5871 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5872 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5873 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5874 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5875 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005876
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005877 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5878 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5879 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005880
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005881 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5882 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5883 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005884
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005885 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005886 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005887 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005889 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5890 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5891 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005892
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005893 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5894 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5895 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005896
5897 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005899 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005900
5901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005902tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5903 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005905 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005906 Arguments :
5907 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5908 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5909 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005910
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005911 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005913 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5914 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5915 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5916 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5917 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005918
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005919 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5920 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5921 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5922 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5923 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5924 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5925 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5926 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5927 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005928
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005929 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5930 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5931 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5932 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005934 Three types of actions are supported :
5935 - accept :
5936 - reject :
5937 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005938
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005939 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5940 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005942 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5943 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5944 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5945 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5946 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5947 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005949 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005950 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5951 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005953 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5954 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5955 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5956 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5957 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005958
5959 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005960 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5961 # and reject everything else.
5962 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5963 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5964 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5965 tcp-request content reject
5966
5967 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005968 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5969 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5970 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005971 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005972
5973 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5974 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5975 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005976 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005977 tcp-request content reject
5978
5979 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5980 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5981
5982 frontend http
5983 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5984 # protecting all our sites
5985 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5986 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5987 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5988 ...
5989 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5990
5991 backend http_dynamic
5992 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5993 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5994 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5995 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5996 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5997 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5998 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006000 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006001
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006002 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006003
6004
6005tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6006 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006008 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006009 Arguments :
6010 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6011 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6012 as explained at the top of this document.
6013
6014 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6015 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6016 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6017 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6018 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6019
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006020 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6021 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6022 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6023 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6024
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006025 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6026 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006027 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006028 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006029 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6030 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6031 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6032 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006033
6034 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6035 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6036 it pass through unaffected.
6037
6038 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6039 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6040 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006041 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006042 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6043 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006044 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6045 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6046 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006047
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006048 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006049 "timeout client".
6050
6051
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006052tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6053 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6055 no | no | yes | yes
6056 Arguments :
6057 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6058 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6059 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6060
6061 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6062
6063 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6064 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6065 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6066 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6067 set and expires with no matching rule.
6068
6069 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6070
6071 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6072 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6073 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6074 inserted.
6075
6076 Two types of actions are supported :
6077 - accept :
6078 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6079 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6080 the rules evaluation.
6081
6082 - reject :
6083 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6084 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6085 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6086
6087 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6088 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6089 for changing the default action to a reject.
6090
6091 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6092 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6093 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6094 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6095 period.
6096
6097 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6098
6099 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6100
6101
6102tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6103 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6105 no | no | yes | yes
6106 Arguments :
6107 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6108 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6109 as explained at the top of this document.
6110
6111 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6112
6113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006114timeout check <timeout>
6115 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6116 established.
6117
6118 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6119 yes | no | yes | yes
6120 Arguments:
6121 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6123 as explained at the top of this document.
6124
6125 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6126 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6127 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6128 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006129 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6130 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6131 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006132
6133 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6134 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6135
6136 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6137 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006138 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006139
6140 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6141 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6142 forget about it.
6143
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006144 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6145 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006146
6147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006148timeout client <timeout>
6149timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6150 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6152 yes | yes | yes | no
6153 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006154 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006155 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6156 as explained at the top of this document.
6157
6158 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6159 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6160 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6161 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6162 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6163 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6164 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6165 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006166 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006167 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6168 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6169
6170 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6171 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6172 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6173 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6174 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6175 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6176
6177 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6178 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6179 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6180
6181 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6182
6183
6184timeout connect <timeout>
6185timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6186 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6188 yes | no | yes | yes
6189 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006190 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006191 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6192 as explained at the top of this document.
6193
6194 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006195 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006196 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006197 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006198 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6199 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006200
6201 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6202 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6203 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6204 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6205 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6206 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6207
6208 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6209 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6210 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6211
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006212 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6213 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006214
6215
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006216timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6217 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6219 yes | yes | yes | yes
6220 Arguments :
6221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6223 as explained at the top of this document.
6224
6225 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6226 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6227 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6228 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6229 once the request has started to present itself.
6230
6231 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6232 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6233 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6234 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6235 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6236
6237 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6238 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6239 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6240 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6241
6242 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6243 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6244 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6245 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6246 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006247 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006248
6249 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6250 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6251 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6252 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6253
6254 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6255
6256
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006257timeout http-request <timeout>
6258 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006261 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006262 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006263 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6264 as explained at the top of this document.
6265
6266 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6267 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6268 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6269 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6270 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6271 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6272 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6273 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6274
6275 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6276 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006277 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6278 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006279
6280 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6281 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6282 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6283 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6284 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6285
6286 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006287 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6288 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6289 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006290
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006291 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006292
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006293
6294timeout queue <timeout>
6295 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6297 yes | no | yes | yes
6298 Arguments :
6299 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6300 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6301 as explained at the top of this document.
6302
6303 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6304 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6305 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6306 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6307 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6308
6309 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6310 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6311 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6312 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6313
6314 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6315
6316
6317timeout server <timeout>
6318timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6319 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 yes | no | yes | yes
6322 Arguments :
6323 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6324 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6325 as explained at the top of this document.
6326
6327 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6328 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6329 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6330 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6331 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6332 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6333 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6334
6335 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6336 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6337 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6338 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6339 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006340 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006341 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006342 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006343
6344 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6345 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6346 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6347 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6348 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6349 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6350
6351 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6352 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6353 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6354
6355 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6356
6357
6358timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006359 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6361 yes | yes | yes | yes
6362 Arguments :
6363 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6364 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6365 as explained at the top of this document.
6366
6367 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6368 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6369 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6370
6371 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6372 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6373 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6374 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006375 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006376
6377 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6378
6379
6380transparent (deprecated)
6381 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006383 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006384 Arguments : none
6385
6386 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6387 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6388 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6389 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6390 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6391 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6392 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6393 appropriate server.
6394
6395 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6396
6397 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6398 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6399
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006400 See also: "option transparent"
6401
6402
6403use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6404use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006405 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6407 no | yes | yes | no
6408 Arguments :
6409 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006411 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006412
6413 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6414 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6415 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006416 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6417 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6418 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6419 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006420
6421 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6422 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6423 assign the backend.
6424
6425 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6426 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6427 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6428 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6429 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6430 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6431
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006432 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006433 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006434 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6435 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6436 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6437
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006438 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006439
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010064415. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006442------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006444The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6445which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6446arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6447settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6448after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6449Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6450address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006452 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006453 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006455The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006457addr <ipv4>
6458 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6459 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6460 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6461 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6462 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006464 Supported in default-server: No
6465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006466backup
6467 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6468 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6469 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6470 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6471 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6472 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006474 Supported in default-server: No
6475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006476check
6477 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6478 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6479 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6480 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6481 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6482 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6483 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6484 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6485 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01006486 "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to
6487 those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006489 Supported in default-server: No
6490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006491cookie <value>
6492 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6493 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6494 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6495 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6496 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6497 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6498 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006500 Supported in default-server: No
6501
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006502disabled
6503 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6504 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6505 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6506 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6507 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6508
6509 Supported in default-server: No
6510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006511error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006512 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6513 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6514 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006516 Supported in default-server: Yes
6517
6518 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006520fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006521 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6522 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6523 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006525 Supported in default-server: Yes
6526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006527id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006528 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6529 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6530 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006532 Supported in default-server: No
6533
6534inter <delay>
6535fastinter <delay>
6536downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006537 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6538 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6539 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6540 between checks depending on the server state :
6541
6542 Server state | Interval used
6543 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6544 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6545 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6546 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6547 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6548 or yet unchecked. |
6549 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6550 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6551 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006553 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6554 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6555 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6556 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6557 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6558 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6559 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6560 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6561 servers.
6562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006563 Supported in default-server: Yes
6564
6565maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006566 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6567 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6568 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6569 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6570 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6571 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6572 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6573 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006575 Supported in default-server: Yes
6576
6577maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006578 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6579 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6580 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6581 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6582 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6583 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6584 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6585
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006586 Supported in default-server: Yes
6587
6588minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006589 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6590 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6591 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6592 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6593 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6594 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006595 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006596 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006598 Supported in default-server: Yes
6599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006600observe <mode>
6601 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6602 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6603 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6604 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6605 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6606 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6607 headers, a timeout, etc.
6608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006609 Supported in default-server: No
6610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006611 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006613on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006614 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6615 Currently, four modes are available:
6616 - fastinter: force fastinter
6617 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6618 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6619 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6620 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006622 Supported in default-server: Yes
6623
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006624 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006626port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006627 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6628 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6629 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6630 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6631 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6632 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006634 Supported in default-server: Yes
6635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006636redir <prefix>
6637 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6638 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6639 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6640 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6641 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6642 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6643 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6644 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006645 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006646 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6647 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6648 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6649 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6650 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6651
6652 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006654 Supported in default-server: No
6655
6656rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006657 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6658 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6659 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006661 Supported in default-server: Yes
6662
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006663send-proxy
6664 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6665 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6666 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6667 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6668 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6669 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6670 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6671 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6672 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6673 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6674 option of the "bind" keyword.
6675
6676 Supported in default-server: No
6677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006678slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006679 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6680 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6681 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6682 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6683 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6684 parameters :
6685
6686 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6687 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6688
6689 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6690 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6691 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6692 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6693
6694 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6695 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6696 seen as failed.
6697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006698 Supported in default-server: Yes
6699
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006700source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006701source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006702source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006703 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6704 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6705 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6706 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6707
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006708 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6709 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6710 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6711 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6712 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6713 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6714 server.
6715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006716 Supported in default-server: No
6717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006718track [<proxy>/]<server>
6719 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6720 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6721 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6722 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6723 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6724
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006725 Supported in default-server: No
6726
6727weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006728 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6729 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6730 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006731 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6732 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6733 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6734 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6735 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6736 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006738 Supported in default-server: Yes
6739
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006740
67416. HTTP header manipulation
6742---------------------------
6743
6744In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6745response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6746request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6747which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6748against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6749to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6750passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6751headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6752never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6753
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006754There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6755(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6756rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6757messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6758in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006759happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006760add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6761normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6764in section 4.2 :
6765
6766 - reqadd <string>
6767 - reqallow <search>
6768 - reqiallow <search>
6769 - reqdel <search>
6770 - reqidel <search>
6771 - reqdeny <search>
6772 - reqideny <search>
6773 - reqpass <search>
6774 - reqipass <search>
6775 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6776 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6777 - reqtarpit <search>
6778 - reqitarpit <search>
6779 - rspadd <string>
6780 - rspdel <search>
6781 - rspidel <search>
6782 - rspdeny <search>
6783 - rspideny <search>
6784 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6785 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6786
6787With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6788is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6789parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6790prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6791Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6792
6793 \t for a tab
6794 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6795 \n for a new line (LF)
6796 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6797 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6798 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6799 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6800 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6801
6802The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6803portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6804above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6805regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
68069 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6807is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6808
6809The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6810after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6811
6812Notes related to these keywords :
6813---------------------------------
6814 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6815 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6816 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6817
6818 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6819 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6820 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6821
6822 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6823 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6824 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6825 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6826 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6827
6828 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6829 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6830 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6831 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6832 useless headers before adding new ones.
6833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006834 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006835 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6836
6837 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6838 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6839 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6840
6841 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6842 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006843 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006844
6845
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010068467. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6847------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006848
6849The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6850content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6851from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6852simple :
6853
6854 - define test criteria with sets of values
6855 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6856
6857The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6858
6859In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6860
6861 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6862
6863This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6864Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6865and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6866an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6867of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6868
6869ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6870'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6871which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6872
6873There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6874performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6875
6876The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6877
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006878 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6879 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006880 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6881
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006882The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6883specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6884possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006885multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6886be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6887needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6888space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6889match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6890lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6891duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6892to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6893instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006894
6895 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6896
6897In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6898the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6899case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6900too.
6901
6902Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6903a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6904ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6905
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006906Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006907
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006908 - integers or integer ranges
6909 - strings
6910 - regular expressions
6911 - IP addresses and networks
6912
6913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069147.1. Matching integers
6915----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006916
6917Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6918that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6919expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6920may be omitted.
6921
6922For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6923unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6924representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6925
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006926As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6927two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6928instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6929ranges and operators.
6930
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006931For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006932operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6933Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6934of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006936Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006937
6938 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6939 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6940 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6941 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6942 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6943
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006944For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006945
6946 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6947
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006948This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6949
6950 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069537.2. Matching strings
6954---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006955
6956String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6957exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6958characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6959string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6960to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006961before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006962
6963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069647.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6965-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006966
6967Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6968they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6969possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6970passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6971the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006972the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6973match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006974
6975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069767.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6977----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006978
6979IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6980netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6981within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006982host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006983difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6984at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6985does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6986parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006987
6988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069897.5. Available matching criteria
6990--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069927.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6993------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006994
6995A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6996analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6997addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006999always_false
7000 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7001 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7002
7003always_true
7004 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7005 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007007avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007008avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007009 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7010 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7011 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7012 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7013 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7014 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7015 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7016 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7017 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7018 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7019 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007020
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007021be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02007022be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007023 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7024 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7025 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7026 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7027 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007028
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007029be_id <integer>
7030 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7031 backend it was called.
7032
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007033be_sess_rate <integer>
7034be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
7035 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7036 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7037 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7038 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7039 sucking of an online dictionary).
7040
7041 Example :
7042 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7043 backend dynamic
7044 mode http
7045 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7046 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007047
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007048connslots <integer>
7049connslots(backend) <integer>
7050 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007051 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007052 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7053
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007054 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7055 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007056
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007057 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007058 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7059 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7060 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7061 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7062 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007063 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007064
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007065 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7066 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7067 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7068 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007069
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007070dst <ip_address>
7071 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7072 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007073
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007074dst_conn <integer>
7075 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7076 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7077 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7078 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7079 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7080 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7081
7082dst_port <integer>
7083 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7084 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7085
7086fe_conn <integer>
7087fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
7088 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7089 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7090 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7091 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7092 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7093 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7094 criteria.
7095
7096fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007097 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007098 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007099
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007100fe_sess_rate <integer>
7101fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
7102 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7103 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7104 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7105 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7106 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7107 the rate to go down below the limit.
7108
7109 Example :
7110 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7111 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7112 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7113 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7114 frontend mail
7115 bind :25
7116 mode tcp
7117 maxconn 100
7118 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7119 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7120 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7121 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007122
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007123nbsrv <integer>
7124nbsrv(backend) <integer>
7125 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7126 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7127 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7128 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7129 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007131queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02007132queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007133 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7134 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7135 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7136 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7137 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7138 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7139 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007141sc1_bytes_in_rate
7142sc2_bytes_in_rate
7143 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7144 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7145 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7146
7147sc1_bytes_out_rate
7148sc2_bytes_out_rate
7149 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7150 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7151 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7152
7153sc1_conn_cnt
7154sc2_conn_cnt
7155 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7156 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7157
7158sc1_conn_cur
7159sc2_conn_cur
7160 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7161 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7162 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7163
7164sc1_conn_rate
7165sc2_conn_rate
7166 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7167 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7168 See also src_conn_rate.
7169
7170sc1_get_gpc0
7171sc2_get_gpc0
7172 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7173 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7174
7175sc1_http_err_cnt
7176sc2_http_err_cnt
7177 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7178 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7179 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7180
7181sc1_http_err_rate
7182sc2_http_err_rate
7183 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7184 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7185 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7186 src_http_err_rate.
7187
7188sc1_http_req_cnt
7189sc2_http_req_cnt
7190 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7191 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7192 src_http_req_cnt.
7193
7194sc1_http_req_rate
7195sc2_http_req_rate
7196 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7197 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7198 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7199 src_http_req_rate.
7200
7201sc1_inc_gpc0
7202sc2_inc_gpc0
7203 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7204 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7205 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7206 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7207 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7208 when a first ACL was verified :
7209
7210 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7211 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7212 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7213
7214sc1_kbytes_in
7215sc2_kbytes_in
7216 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7217 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7218 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7219 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7220
7221sc1_kbytes_out
7222sc2_kbytes_out
7223 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7224 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7225 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7226 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7227
7228sc1_sess_cnt
7229sc2_sess_cnt
7230 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7231 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7232 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7233 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7234 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7235 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7236
7237sc1_sess_rate
7238sc2_sess_rate
7239 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7240 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7241 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7242 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7243 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7244 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7245
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007246so_id <integer>
7247 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7248
7249src <ip_address>
7250 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7251 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7252 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7253
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007254src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
7255src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
7256 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7257 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7258 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007259 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007260
7261src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
7262src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
7263 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7264 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7265 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007266 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007267
7268src_conn_cnt <integer>
7269src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
7270 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7271 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7272 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007273 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007274
7275src_conn_cur <integer>
7276src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
7277 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7278 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7279 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007280 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007281
7282src_conn_rate <integer>
7283src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
7284 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7285 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7286 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007287 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007288
7289src_get_gpc0 <integer>
7290src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
7291 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7292 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7293 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007294 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007295
7296src_http_err_cnt <integer>
7297src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
7298 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7299 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7300 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007301 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007302
7303src_http_err_rate <integer>
7304src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
7305 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7306 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7307 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7308 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007309 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007310
7311src_http_req_cnt <integer>
7312src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
7313 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7314 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7315 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007316 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007317
7318src_http_req_rate <integer>
7319src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
7320 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7321 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7322 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7323 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007324 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007325
7326src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
7327src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
7328 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7329 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7330 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7331 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7332 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7333 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7334
7335 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7336 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007337 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007338
7339src_kbytes_in <integer>
7340src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
7341 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7342 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7343 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7344 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007345 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007346
7347src_kbytes_out <integer>
7348src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
7349 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7350 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7351 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7352 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007353 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007354
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007355src_port <integer>
7356 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007357
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007358src_sess_cnt <integer>
7359src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
7360 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7361 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7362 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7363 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007364 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007365
7366src_sess_rate <integer>
7367src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
7368 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7369 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7370 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7371 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007372 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007373
7374src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
7375src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007376 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007377 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7378 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007379 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7380 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7381 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007382 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007383
7384 Example :
7385 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7386 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7387 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7388 listen ssh
7389 bind :22
7390 mode tcp
7391 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007392 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007393 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7394 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7395
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007396srv_id <integer>
7397 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7398
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007399srv_is_up(<server>)
7400srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7401 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7402 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7403 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7404 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7405 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7406 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7407 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7408 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7409
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007410table_avl <integer>
7411table_avl(table) <integer>
7412 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7413 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7414
7415table_cnt <integer>
7416table_cnt(table) <integer>
7417 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7418 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7419 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7420
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007421
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020074227.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7423---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007424
7425A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7426during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007427through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7428keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007429
7430req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007431 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007432 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7433 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7434 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7435 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7436 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7437 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7438
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007439req_proto_http
7440 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7441 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007442 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007443 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7444 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7445
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007446req_rdp_cookie <string>
7447req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
7448 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7449 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7450 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7451 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7452 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7453 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7454 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7455 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7456
7457req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
7458req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
7459 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7460 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7461 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7462 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7463 cookies.
7464
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007465req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7466 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7467 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7468 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7469 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7470 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7471 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7472 with TCP request content inspection.
7473
Emeric Brun392d1d82010-09-24 15:45:16 +02007474req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7475 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7476 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7477 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7478 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7479
7480rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7481 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7482 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7483 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7484 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7485
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007486wait_end
7487 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7488 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7489 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7490 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7491 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7492 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7493 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7494 inspection.
7495
7496 Examples :
7497 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7498 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7499 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7500
7501 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7502 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7503 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7504 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7505 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7506 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7507 tcp-request content reject
7508
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075107.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7511--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007512
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007513A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007514application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7515read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7516than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7517
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007518hdr <string>
7519hdr(header) <string>
7520 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7521 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7522 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7523 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7524 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7525
7526 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7527 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7528 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7529
7530 hdr(Connection) -i close
7531
7532hdr_beg <string>
7533hdr_beg(header) <string>
7534 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7535 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7536 response headers sent by the server.
7537
7538hdr_cnt <integer>
7539hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7540 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7541 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7542 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7543 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7544 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7545 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7546 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7547
7548hdr_dir <string>
7549hdr_dir(header) <string>
7550 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7551 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7552 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7553 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7554 headers sent by the server.
7555
7556hdr_dom <string>
7557hdr_dom(header) <string>
7558 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7559 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7560 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7561 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7562 server.
7563
7564hdr_end <string>
7565hdr_end(header) <string>
7566 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7567 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7568 response headers sent by the server.
7569
7570hdr_ip <ip_address>
7571hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7572 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7573 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7574 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7575 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7576
7577hdr_reg <regex>
7578hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7579 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7580 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7581 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7582 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7583 response headers sent by the server.
7584
7585hdr_sub <string>
7586hdr_sub(header) <string>
7587 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7588 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7589 response headers sent by the server.
7590
7591hdr_val <integer>
7592hdr_val(header) <integer>
7593 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7594 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7595 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7596 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7597
7598http_auth(userlist)
7599http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7600 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7601 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7602 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7603 of specified groups.
7604
7605 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7606
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02007607http_req_first
7608 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
7609 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
7610 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
7611 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
7612
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007613method <string>
7614 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7615 already check for most common methods.
7616
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007617path <string>
7618 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7619 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7620 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7621
7622path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007623 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7624 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007626path_dir <string>
7627 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7628 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7629 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7630 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7631
7632path_dom <string>
7633 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7634 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7635 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7636
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007637path_end <string>
7638 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7639 control file name extension.
7640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007641path_reg <regex>
7642 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7643 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7644 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007646path_sub <string>
7647 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7648 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7649 "path_dir".
7650
7651req_ver <string>
7652 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7653 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7654
7655status <integer>
7656 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7657 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7658 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7659
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007660url <string>
7661 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7662 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7663
7664url_beg <string>
7665 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7666 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007668url_dir <string>
7669 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7670 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7671 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7672 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7673
7674url_dom <string>
7675 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7676 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7677 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7678
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007679url_end <string>
7680 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7681 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007682
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007683url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007684 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7685 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007686 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007687
7688url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007689 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7690 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007691 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007692 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007693
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007694url_reg <regex>
7695 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7696 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7697 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007698
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007699url_sub <string>
7700 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7701 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007702
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077047.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7705---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007707Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7708every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007709order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007711ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7712---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007713FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007714HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007715HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7716HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007717HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7718HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7719HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7720HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7721LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007722METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7723METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7724METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7725METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7726METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7727METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007728RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007729REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007730TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007731WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7732---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007733
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077357.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7736----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007738Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7739combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007741 - AND (implicit)
7742 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7743 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007745A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007747 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007749Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7750indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007752For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7753"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7754requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7755is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007757 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7758 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7759 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7760 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007762To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7763and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007765 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7766 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7767 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7768 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007770 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7771 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7772 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7773 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007774
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007775It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7776expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7777be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7778the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7779
7780 The following rule :
7781
7782 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7783 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7784
7785 Can also be written that way :
7786
7787 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7788
7789It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7790to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7791simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7792sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7793good use is the following :
7794
7795 With named ACLs :
7796
7797 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7798 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7799 monitor fail if site_dead
7800
7801 With anonymous ACLs :
7802
7803 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007805See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007806
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007807
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010078087.8. Pattern extraction
7809-----------------------
7810
7811The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7812response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7813for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7814
7815All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7816"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7817begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7818arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7819much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7820equivalent used in ACLs.
7821
7822The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7823
7824 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007825 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7826 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7827 according to RFC 4291.
7828
7829 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
7830 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007831
7832 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7833 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7834 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007835 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
7836 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
7837 according to RFC 4291.
7838
7839 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
7840 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7841 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7842 typie IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007843
7844 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7845 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7846 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7847 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7848 type integer and only works with such tables.
7849
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007850 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7851 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7852 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7853 x-forwarded-for header.
7854
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007855 payload(offset,length)
7856 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
7857 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
7858 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
7859 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007860
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007861 payload_lv(offset1,length[,offset2])
7862 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
7863 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
7864 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
7865 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
7866 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
7867 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
7868 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
7869 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
7870
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09007871 url_param(name)
7872 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
7873 the query string of the request and uses the correponding value
7874 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
7875 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
7876 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
7877
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007878The currently available list of transformations include :
7879
7880 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7881 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7882 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7883
7884 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7885 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7886 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7887
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007888 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7889 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7890 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7891 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7892 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7893
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078958. Logging
7896----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007897
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007898One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7899provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7900very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7901provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7902state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007903to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007904headers.
7905
7906In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7907about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7908send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7909
7910 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7911 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7912 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7913 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7914 at the termination.
7915
7916The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7917allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7918as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7919while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7920real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7921delay.
7922
7923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079248.1. Log levels
7925---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007926
7927TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7928source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7929HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7930in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7931particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007932syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007933facilities.
7934
7935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079368.2. Log formats
7937----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007938
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007939HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007940and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7941the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7942formats are the following ones :
7943
7944 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7945 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7946 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7947 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7948 extents.
7949
7950 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7951 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7952 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7953 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7954 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7955
7956 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7957 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7958 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7959 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7960 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7961
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007962 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7963 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7964 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7965 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7966
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007967Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7968specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7969field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7970servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7971always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7972identifier.
7973
7974Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7975 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7976 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7977 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7978 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7979
7980
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079818.2.1. Default log format
7982-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007983
7984This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7985as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7986format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7987
7988 Example :
7989 listen www
7990 mode http
7991 log global
7992 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7993
7994 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7995 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7996 (www/HTTP)
7997
7998 Field Format Extract from the example above
7999 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8000 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8001 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8002 4 'to' to
8003 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8004 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8005
8006Detailed fields description :
8007 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8008 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8009 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8010 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8011 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8012 and processed the connection.
8013 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8014
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008015In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8016"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8017connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8018
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008019It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8020will eventually disappear.
8021
8022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080238.2.2. TCP log format
8024---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008025
8026The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8027is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8028information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8029counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8030emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8031environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8032the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8033sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008034specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8035not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8036fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8037marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008038
8039 Example :
8040 frontend fnt
8041 mode tcp
8042 option tcplog
8043 log global
8044 default_backend bck
8045
8046 backend bck
8047 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8048
8049 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8050 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8051 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8052
8053 Field Format Extract from the example above
8054 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8055 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8056 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8057 4 frontend_name fnt
8058 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8059 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8060 7 bytes_read* 212
8061 8 termination_state --
8062 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8063 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8064
8065Detailed fields description :
8066 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008067 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8068 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8069 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8070 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8071 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008072
8073 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008074 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8075 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8076 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008077
8078 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8079 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8080 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8081 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8082
8083 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8084 and processed the connection.
8085
8086 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8087 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8088 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8089 applications.
8090
8091 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8092 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8093 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8094 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8095 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8096
8097 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8098 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8099 See "Timers" below for more details.
8100
8101 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8102 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8103 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8104 "Timers" below for more details.
8105
8106 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8107 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8108 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8109 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8110 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8111 details.
8112
8113 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8114 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8115 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8116 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8117 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8118
8119 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8120 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8121 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8122 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8123 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8124 for more details.
8125
8126 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8127 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8128 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8129 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8130 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008131 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008132
8133 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8134 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8135 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8136 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8137 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8138 caused by a denial of service attack.
8139
8140 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8141 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8142 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8143 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8144 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8145 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8146 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8147 denial of service attack.
8148
8149 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8150 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8151 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8152 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8153 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8154 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8155 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8156 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8157 be processed than on other servers.
8158
8159 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8160 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8161 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8162 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8163 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8164 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8165 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8166 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8167 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8168 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8169 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8170 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8171 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8172
8173 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8174 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8175 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8176 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8177 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8178 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8179 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8180 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8181
8182 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8183 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8184 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8185 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8186 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8187 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8188 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8189 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8190 occurs.
8191
8192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081938.2.3. HTTP log format
8194----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008195
8196The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8197is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8198the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8199are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8200emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8201generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8202"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8203which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008204frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8205is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008206
8207Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8208slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8209with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8210
8211 Example :
8212 frontend http-in
8213 mode http
8214 option httplog
8215 log global
8216 default_backend bck
8217
8218 backend static
8219 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8220
8221 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8222 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8223 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008224 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008225
8226 Field Format Extract from the example above
8227 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8228 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8229 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8230 4 frontend_name http-in
8231 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8232 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8233 7 status_code 200
8234 8 bytes_read* 2750
8235 9 captured_request_cookie -
8236 10 captured_response_cookie -
8237 11 termination_state ----
8238 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8239 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8240 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8241 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8242 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008243
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008244
8245Detailed fields description :
8246 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008247 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8248 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8249 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8250 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8251 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008252
8253 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008254 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8255 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8256 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008257
8258 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8259 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8260 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8261 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8262 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8263
8264 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8265 and processed the connection.
8266
8267 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8268 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8269 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8270
8271 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8272 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8273 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8274 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8275 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8276 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8277
8278 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8279 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8280 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8281 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8282 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8283 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8284
8285 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8286 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8287 See "Timers" below for more details.
8288
8289 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8290 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8291 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8292 below for more details.
8293
8294 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8295 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8296 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8297 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8298 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8299 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8300 for more details.
8301
8302 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8303 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8304 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8305 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8306 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8307 details.
8308
8309 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8310 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8311 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8312
8313 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8314 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8315 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8316 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8317 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8318 overflowing.
8319
8320 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8321 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8322 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8323 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8324 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8325 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8326 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8327 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8328
8329 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8330 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8331 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8332 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8333 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8334 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8335 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8336 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8337
8338 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8339 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8340 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8341 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8342 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8343 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8344 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8345
8346 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8347 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8348 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8349 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8350 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008351 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008352 system.
8353
8354 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8355 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8356 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8357 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8358 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8359 caused by a denial of service attack.
8360
8361 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8362 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8363 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8364 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8365 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8366 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8367 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8368 denial of service attack.
8369
8370 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8371 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8372 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8373 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8374 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8375 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8376 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8377 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8378 processed than on other servers.
8379
8380 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8381 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8382 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8383 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8384 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8385 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8386 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8387 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8388 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8389 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8390 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8391 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8392 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8393
8394 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8395 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8396 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8397 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8398 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8399 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8400 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8401 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8402
8403 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8404 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8405 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8406 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8407 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8408 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8409 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8410 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8411 occurs.
8412
8413 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8414 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8415 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8416 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8417 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8418 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8419 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8420 cookies" below for more details.
8421
8422 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8423 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8424 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8425 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8426 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8427 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8428 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8429 and cookies" below for more details.
8430
8431 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8432 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8433 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8434 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8435 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8436 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8437 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8438 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8439
8440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084418.3. Advanced logging options
8442-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008443
8444Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
8445just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
8446options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
8447for more information about their usage.
8448
8449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084508.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
8451------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008452
8453It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
8454haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
8455commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
8456monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
8457ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
8458
8459 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
8460 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
8461 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
8462 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
8463
8464 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
8465 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
8466 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
8467 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
8468 such as other load-balancers.
8469
8470 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
8471 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
8472 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
8473
8474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084758.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
8476----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008477
8478The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
8479what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
8480or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
8481"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
8482just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
8483log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
8484after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
8485is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
8486with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
8487with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
8488
8489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
8491------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008492
8493Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
8494for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
8495"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
8496retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
8497raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
8498a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
8499file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
8500you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
8501"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
8502
8503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
8505--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008506
8507Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
8508multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
8509them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
8510"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
8511logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
8512error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
8513and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
8514too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
8515useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
8516alternative.
8517
8518
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085198.4. Timing events
8520------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008521
8522Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
8523reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
8524the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
8525frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
8526mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
8527
8528 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
8529 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
8530 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
8531 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
8532 the client closes prematurely or times out.
8533
8534 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8535 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8536 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8537 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8538 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8539
8540 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8541 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8542 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8543 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8544 connection never established.
8545
8546 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8547 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8548 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8549 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8550 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8551 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8552 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8553 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8554 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8555 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8556 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8557
8558 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8559 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8560 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8561 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8562 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8563
8564 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8565
8566 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8567 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8568 negative.
8569
8570These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8571protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8572that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008573due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008574close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8575session has been aborted on timeout.
8576
8577Most common cases :
8578
8579 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8580 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8581 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8582 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8583 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8584 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8585 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8586 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8587 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008588 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8589 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8590 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008591
8592 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8593 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8594 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8595 of ms on remote networks.
8596
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008597 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8598 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8599 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008600
8601 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8602 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8603 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8604 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8605 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8606 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8607 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8608 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8609 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8610 to the server until another one is released.
8611
8612Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8613
8614 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8615 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8616 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8617
8618 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8619 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8620 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8621
8622 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8623 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8624 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8625 flags.
8626
8627 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8628 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8629 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8630 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8631 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8632 the client connection was maintained open.
8633
8634 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8635 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8636 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8637 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8638
8639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086408.5. Session state at disconnection
8641-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008642
8643TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8644"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
86452-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8646each of which has a special meaning :
8647
8648 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8649 session to terminate :
8650
8651 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8652
8653 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8654 server explicitly refused it.
8655
8656 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8657 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8658 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8659 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8660 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8661 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8662
8663 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8664 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8665 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8666 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8667 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8668
8669 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8670 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8671 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8672 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8673 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8674
8675 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8676 send or receive data.
8677
8678 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8679 send or receive data.
8680
8681 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8682 with nothing left in the buffers.
8683
8684 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8685
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01008686 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008687 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8688
8689 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8690 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8691 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8692 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8693 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8694
8695 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8696 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8697
8698 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8699 server (HTTP only).
8700
8701 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8702
8703 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8704 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8705 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8706
8707 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8708 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8709 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8710
8711 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8712
8713 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8714 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8715
8716 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8717 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8718 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8719
8720 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8721 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008722 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8723 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008724
8725 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8726 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8727 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8728 another server.
8729
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008730 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008731 server.
8732
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008733 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8734 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8735 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8736 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8737
8738 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8739 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8740 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8741 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8742
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008743 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8744
8745 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8746 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8747
8748 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8749
8750 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8751 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8752 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8753
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008754 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8755 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8756 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8757 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8758 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008760 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8761
8762 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8763 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8764
8765 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8766
8767 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8768
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008769The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8770was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008771helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8772starvation, attacks, etc...
8773
8774The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8775alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8776easier finding and understanding.
8777
8778 Flags Reason
8779
8780 -- Normal termination.
8781
8782 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8783 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8784 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8785 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8786
8787 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8788 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8789 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8790 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8791 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8792 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008793
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008794 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8795 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8796 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8797
8798 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8799 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8800 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8801
8802 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8803 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8804 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8805 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8806 the server takes too long to respond.
8807
8808 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8809 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8810 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8811 long a time to respond.
8812
8813 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8814 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8815 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8816 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8817 and the client.
8818
8819 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8820 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8821 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8822 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8823 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8824 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8825
8826 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8827 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008828 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8829 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8830 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8831 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008833 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008834 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8835 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8836 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8837 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8838 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8839
8840 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8841 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8842 503 or 504 here.
8843
8844 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8845 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8846 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8847 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8848 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8849
8850 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8851 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008852 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008853 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8854 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8855
8856 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8857 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8858 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8859 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8860 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8861 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8862 between haproxy and the server.
8863
8864 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8865 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8866 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8867 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8868 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8869 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8870 solution is to fix the application.
8871
8872 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8873 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8874 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8875 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8876 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8877 external attacks.
8878
8879 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8880 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8881 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8882 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8883 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8884
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008885 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
8886 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
8887 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
8888 the client.
8889
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008890 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8891 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8892 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8893 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01008894 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
8895 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
8896 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
8897 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
8898 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008899
8900 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8901 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8902 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8903 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8904
8905 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8906 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8907 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8908 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8909
8910 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8911 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8912 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8913 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8914
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008915The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8916persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8917important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8918re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8919
8920 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8921
8922 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8923 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8924 set on a GET request.
8925
8926 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8927 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8928 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8929 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8930
8931 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8932 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8933 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8934
8935 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8936 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8937 already got a cookie.
8938
8939 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8940 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8941 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8942 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8943 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8944
8945 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8946 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8947 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8948
8949 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8950 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8951 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8952
8953 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8954 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8955
8956 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8957 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8958 then advertised in the response.
8959
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089618.6. Non-printable characters
8962-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008963
8964In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8965consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8966converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8967prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8968being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8969escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8970is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8971'}' when logging headers.
8972
8973Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8974issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8975containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8976
8977Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8978the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8979performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8980
8981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089828.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8983---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008984
8985Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8986achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008987section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008988cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8989the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8990the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008991locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008992not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8993user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8994a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8995wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8996
8997 Examples :
8998 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8999 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9000
9001 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9002 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9003
9004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090058.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9006---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009007
9008Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9009proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9010the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9011server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9012
9013Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9014response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009015section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009016
9017It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009018time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9019appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009020are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9021and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9022follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9023request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9024in the logs.
9025
9026 Example :
9027 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9028 listen proxy-out
9029 mode http
9030 option httplog
9031 option logasap
9032 log global
9033 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9034
9035 # log the name of the virtual server
9036 capture request header Host len 20
9037
9038 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9039 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9040
9041 # log the beginning of the referrer
9042 capture request header Referer len 20
9043
9044 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9045 capture response header Server len 20
9046
9047 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9048 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9049
9050 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9051 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9052
9053 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9054 capture response header Via len 20
9055
9056 # log the URL location during a redirection
9057 capture response header Location len 20
9058
9059 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9060 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9061 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9062 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9063 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9064
9065 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9066 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9067 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9068 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009069 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009070
9071 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9072 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9073 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9074 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9075 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009076 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009077
9078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090798.9. Examples of logs
9080---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009081
9082These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9083them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9084reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9085
9086 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9087 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9088 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9089
9090 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9091 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9092
9093 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9094 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9095 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9096
9097 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9098 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9099
9100 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9101 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9102 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9103
9104 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009105 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009106 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9107 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9108
9109 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9110 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9111 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9112
9113 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9114 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
9115 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
9116 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9117 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9118 to return the 502 and not the server.
9119
9120 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009121 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009122
9123 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9124 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9125 Nothing was sent to any server.
9126
9127 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9128 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9129
9130 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9131 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9132 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9133 send a 408 return code to the client.
9134
9135 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9136 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9137
9138 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9139 5 seconds ("c----").
9140
9141 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9142 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009143 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009144
9145 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009146 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009147 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9148 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9149 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9150 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9151 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009152
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091549. Statistics and monitoring
9155----------------------------
9156
9157It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9158mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9159CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9160Unix socket.
9161
9162
91639.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009164---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009165
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009166The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9167page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009169 0. pxname: proxy name
9170 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9171 for server)
9172 2. qcur: current queued requests
9173 3. qmax: max queued requests
9174 4. scur: current sessions
9175 5. smax: max sessions
9176 6. slim: sessions limit
9177 7. stot: total sessions
9178 8. bin: bytes in
9179 9. bout: bytes out
9180 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009181 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009182 12. ereq: request errors
9183 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009184 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009185 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9186 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009187 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009188 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9189 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9190 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9191 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9192 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9193 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9194 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9195 25. qlimit: queue limit
9196 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9197 27. iid: unique proxy id
9198 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9199 29. throttle: warm up status
9200 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9201 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009202 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009203 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9204 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9205 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009206 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009207 UNK -> unknown
9208 INI -> initializing
9209 SOCKERR -> socket error
9210 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9211 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9212 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9213 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9214 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9215 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9216 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9217 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9218 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9219 disable-on-404
9220 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9221 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9222 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009223 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9224 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009225 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9226 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9227 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9228 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9229 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9230 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009231 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9232 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9233 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9234 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009235 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9236 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009237
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092399.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009240-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009241
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009242The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009243must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9244is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9245a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9246risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9247followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9248given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9249then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9250to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009251
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009252It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9253on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9254own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009255
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009256clear counters
9257 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9258 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9259 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9260 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9261 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9262
9263clear counters all
9264 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9265 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9266 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9267
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009268clear table <table> key <key>
9269 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
9270 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
9271 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
9272 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
9273 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
9274 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
9275 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
9276 usuall enough.
9277
9278 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009279 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009280 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009281 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9282 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9283 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9284 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009285
9286 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9287
9288 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009289 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009290 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9291 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009292
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009293disable server <backend>/<server>
9294 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9295 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9296 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9297 during the maintenance.
9298
9299 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9300 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9301
9302 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9303 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9304
9305 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9306 level "admin".
9307
9308enable server <backend>/<server>
9309 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9310 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9311
9312 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
9313 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9314
9315 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9316 level "admin".
9317
9318get weight <backend>/<server>
9319 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9320 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9321 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9322 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9323 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
9324 dash ('#').
9325
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009326help
9327 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9328 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009329
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009330prompt
9331 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9332 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9333 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9334 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9335 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9336 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9337 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9338 command.
9339
9340quit
9341 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009342
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009343set timeout cli <delay>
9344 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
9345 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
9346 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
9347
9348set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
9349 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
9350 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
9351 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
9352 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
9353 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
9354 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
9355 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
9356 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
9357 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
9358 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
9359 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
9360 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
9361 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
9362 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
9363
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009364show errors [<iid>]
9365 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
9366 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009367 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
9368 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
9369 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009370
9371 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
9372 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
9373 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
9374 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
9375 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
9376 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
9377 are reported too.
9378
9379 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
9380 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
9381 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
9382 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
9383 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
9384 code.
9385
9386 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
9387 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
9388 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
9389 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
9390 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
9391 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
9392 line.
9393
9394 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009395 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9396 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009397 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
9398 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
9399
9400 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
9401 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
9402 00038 Location: blah\r\n
9403 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
9404 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
9405 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
9406 00204+ minal\r\n
9407 00211 \r\n
9408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009409 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01009410 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
9411 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
9412 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
9413 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
9414 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
9415 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009416
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009417show info
9418 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
9419
9420show sess
9421 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02009422 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
9423 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9424
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01009425show sess <id>
9426 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
9427 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
9428 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
9429 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
9430 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
9431 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009432
9433show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
9434 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
9435 possible to dump only selected items :
9436 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
9437 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
9438 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
9439 for example:
9440 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
9441 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
9442 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
9443
9444 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009445 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
9446 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009447 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
9448 Release_date: 2009/09/23
9449 Nbproc: 1
9450 Process_num: 1
9451 (...)
9452
9453 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
9454 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
9455 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
9456 (...)
9457 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
9458
9459 $
9460
9461 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
9462 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
9463 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
9464 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009465 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009466
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009467show table
9468 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
9469 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
9470 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
9471 entries currently in use.
9472
9473 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009474 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9475 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
9476 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009477
9478show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
9479 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
9480 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
9481 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
9482 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
9483 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
9484 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
9485 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
9486 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
9487 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9488 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9489 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9490 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9491 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9492 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9493
9494 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009495 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9496 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9497 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9498 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9499 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9500 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009501
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009502 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9503 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9504 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9505 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009506
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009507 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
9508 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9509 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
9510 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9511 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009512
9513 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
9514 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
9515 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
9516 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
9517 time goes, the average event rate drops.
9518
9519 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
9520 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
9521 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009522 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
9523 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009524 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
9525 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02009526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009527/*
9528 * Local variables:
9529 * fill-column: 79
9530 * End:
9531 */